Merge from emacs-23
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5
6 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7
8 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
11 (at your option) any later version.
12
13 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
17
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20
21 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
22 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23
24 #include <config.h>
25 #include <signal.h>
26 #include <stdio.h>
27 #include <setjmp.h>
28
29 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
30
31 #include "lisp.h"
32 #include "blockinput.h"
33
34 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
35 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
36 #include "syssignal.h"
37
38 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
39 if this is not done before the other system files. */
40 #include "xterm.h"
41 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
42
43 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
44 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
45 #ifndef makedev
46 #include <sys/types.h>
47 #endif /* makedev */
48
49 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
50
51 #include "systime.h"
52
53 #include <fcntl.h>
54 #include <ctype.h>
55 #include <errno.h>
56 #include <setjmp.h>
57 #include <sys/stat.h>
58 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
59 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
60
61 #include "charset.h"
62 #include "character.h"
63 #include "coding.h"
64 #include "frame.h"
65 #include "dispextern.h"
66 #include "fontset.h"
67 #include "termhooks.h"
68 #include "termopts.h"
69 #include "termchar.h"
70 #include "emacs-icon.h"
71 #include "disptab.h"
72 #include "buffer.h"
73 #include "window.h"
74 #include "keyboard.h"
75 #include "intervals.h"
76 #include "process.h"
77 #include "atimer.h"
78 #include "keymap.h"
79 #include "font.h"
80 #include "fontset.h"
81 #include "xsettings.h"
82 #include "xgselect.h"
83 #include "sysselect.h"
84
85 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
86 #include <X11/Shell.h>
87 #endif
88
89 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
90 #include <sys/time.h>
91 #endif
92 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
93 #include <unistd.h>
94 #endif
95
96 #ifdef USE_GTK
97 #include "gtkutil.h"
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_LUCID
101 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
105 #if !defined(NO_EDITRES)
106 #define HACK_EDITRES
107 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
108 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
109
110 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
111
112 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
113 #if defined USE_MOTIF
114 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
115 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
116 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
117
118 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
120 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
121 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
122 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
123 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
124 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
125 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
126 #ifndef XtNpickTop
127 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
128 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
129 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
130 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
131
132 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
133
134 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
135 #include "widget.h"
136 #ifndef XtNinitialState
137 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
138 #endif
139 #endif
140
141 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
142 #ifdef USE_XIM
143 int use_xim = 1;
144 #else
145 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
146 #endif
147
148 \f
149
150 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
151
152 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
153
154 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
155 start. */
156
157 static int any_help_event_p;
158
159 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
160 static Lisp_Object last_window;
161
162 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
163
164 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
165
166 /* Non-zero means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line. */
167
168 int x_underline_at_descent_line;
169
170 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
171 use. */
172
173 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
174
175 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
176 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
177 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
178 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
179
180 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
181
182 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
183 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
184 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
185 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
186
187 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
188
189 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
190
191 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
192
193 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
194
195 static struct {
196 struct frame *f;
197 int eventtype;
198 } pending_event_wait;
199
200 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
201 /* The application context for Xt use. */
202 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
203 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
204 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
205
206 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
207
208 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
209
210 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
211 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
212
213 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
214
215 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
216 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
217 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
218
219 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
220
221 /* Mouse movement.
222
223 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
224 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
225 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
226 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
227
228 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
229
230 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
231 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
232 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
233 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
234 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
235 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
236 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
237 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
238 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
239 is off. */
240
241 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
242
243 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
244 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
245 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
246
247 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
248
249 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
250 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
251 an ordinary motion.
252
253 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
254 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
255 event. */
256
257 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
258
259 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
260 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
261 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
262 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
263 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
264 it's somewhat accurate. */
265
266 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
267
268 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
269
270 static Time last_user_time;
271
272 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
273 events. */
274
275 #ifdef __STDC__
276 static int volatile input_signal_count;
277 #else
278 static int input_signal_count;
279 #endif
280
281 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
282
283 static int x_noop_count;
284
285 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
286
287 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
288 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
289 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
290
291 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
292 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
293
294 #ifdef USE_GTK
295 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
296 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
297
298 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
299 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
300 #endif
301
302 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
303 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
304
305 /* XEmbed implementation. */
306
307 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
308
309 enum xembed_info
310 {
311 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
312 };
313
314 enum xembed_message
315 {
316 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
317 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
318 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
319 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
320 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
321 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
322 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
323 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
324
325 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
326 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
327 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
328 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
329 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
330 };
331
332 /* Used in x_flush. */
333
334 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
335 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
336 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
337 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
338
339 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
340 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
341 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
342 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
343 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
344 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
345 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
346 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
347 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
348 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
349 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
350 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
351 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
352 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
353 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
354 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
355 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
356 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
357 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
358 enum text_cursor_kinds);
359
360 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
361 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
362 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
363 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
364 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
365 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
366 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
367 enum scroll_bar_part *,
368 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
369 unsigned long *);
370 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
371 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
372 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
373 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
374 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
375 int *, struct input_event *);
376 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
377 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
378 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
379
380
381 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
382
383 static void
384 x_flush (struct frame *f)
385 {
386 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
387 connection may be broken. */
388 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
389 return;
390
391 BLOCK_INPUT;
392 if (f == NULL)
393 {
394 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
395 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
396 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
397 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
398 }
399 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
400 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
401 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
402 }
403
404
405 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
406 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
407 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
408 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
409 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
410 performance. */
411
412 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
413
414 \f
415 /***********************************************************************
416 Debugging
417 ***********************************************************************/
418
419 #if 0
420
421 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
422 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
423
424 struct record
425 {
426 char *locus;
427 int type;
428 };
429
430 struct record event_record[100];
431
432 int event_record_index;
433
434 void
435 record_event (char *locus, int type)
436 {
437 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
438 event_record_index = 0;
439
440 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
441 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
442 event_record_index++;
443 }
444
445 #endif /* 0 */
446
447
448 \f
449 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
450
451 struct x_display_info *
452 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
453 {
454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
455
456 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
457 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
458 return dpyinfo;
459
460 return 0;
461 }
462
463 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
464
465 void
466 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
467 {
468 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
469 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
470 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
471 double alpha = 1.0;
472 double alpha_min = 1.0;
473 unsigned long opac;
474
475 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window != FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc)
476 /* Since the WM decoration lies under the FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW,
477 we must treat the former instead of the latter. */
478 win = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
479
480 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
481 alpha = f->alpha[0];
482 else
483 alpha = f->alpha[1];
484
485 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
486 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
487 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
488 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
489
490 if (alpha < 0.0)
491 return;
492 else if (alpha > 1.0)
493 alpha = 1.0;
494 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
495 alpha = alpha_min;
496
497 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
498
499 /* return unless necessary */
500 {
501 unsigned char *data;
502 Atom actual;
503 int rc, format;
504 unsigned long n, left;
505
506 x_catch_errors (dpy);
507 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
508 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
509 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
510 &data);
511
512 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
513 {
514 XFree ((void *) data);
515 if (*(unsigned long *)data == opac)
516 {
517 x_uncatch_errors ();
518 return;
519 }
520 }
521 x_uncatch_errors ();
522 }
523
524 x_catch_errors (dpy);
525 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
526 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
527 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
528 x_uncatch_errors ();
529 }
530
531 int
532 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
533 {
534 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
535 }
536
537 int
538 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
539 {
540 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
541 }
542
543 \f
544 /***********************************************************************
545 Starting and ending an update
546 ***********************************************************************/
547
548 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
549 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
550 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
551 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
552 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
553
554 static void
555 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
556 {
557 /* Nothing to do. */
558 }
559
560
561 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
562 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
563 position of W. */
564
565 static void
566 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
567 {
568 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
569 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
570
571 updated_window = w;
572 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
573
574 BLOCK_INPUT;
575
576 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
577 {
578 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
579 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
580
581 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
582 highlighting. */
583 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
584 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
585 }
586
587 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
588 }
589
590
591 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
592
593 static void
594 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
595 {
596 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
597 struct face *face;
598
599 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
600 if (face)
601 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
602 face->foreground);
603
604 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
605 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
606 }
607
608 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
609
610 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
611 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
612
613 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
614 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
615 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
616
617 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
618 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
619 here. */
620
621 static void
622 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
623 {
624 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
625
626 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
627 {
628 BLOCK_INPUT;
629
630 if (cursor_on_p)
631 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
632 output_cursor.vpos,
633 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
634
635 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
636 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
637
638 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
639 }
640
641 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
642 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
643 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
644 {
645 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
646 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
647 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
648 }
649
650 updated_window = NULL;
651 }
652
653
654 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
655 update_end. */
656
657 static void
658 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
659 {
660 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
661 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
662
663 #ifndef XFlush
664 BLOCK_INPUT;
665 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
666 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
667 #endif
668 }
669
670
671 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
672 complete update has been performed. The global variable
673 updated_window is not available here. */
674
675 static void
676 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
677 {
678 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
679 {
680 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
681
682 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
683 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
684 {
685 BLOCK_INPUT;
686 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
687 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
688 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
689 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
690 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
691 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
692 }
693 }
694 }
695
696
697 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
698 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
699 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
700 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
701 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
702 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
703
704 static void
705 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
706 {
707 struct window *w = updated_window;
708 struct frame *f;
709 int width, height;
710
711 xassert (w);
712
713 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
714 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
715
716 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
717 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
718 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
719 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
720 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
721 overhead is very small. */
722 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
723 && desired_row->full_width_p
724 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
725 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
726 width != 0)
727 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
728 height > 0))
729 {
730 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
731
732 BLOCK_INPUT;
733 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
734 0, y, width, height, False);
735 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
736 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
737 y, width, height, False);
738 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
739 }
740 }
741
742 static void
743 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
744 {
745 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
746 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
747 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
748 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
749 struct face *face = p->face;
750
751 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
752 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
753
754 if (!p->overlay_p)
755 {
756 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
757
758 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
759 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
760 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
761 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
762 if (face->stipple)
763 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
764 else
765 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
766
767 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
768 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
769 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
770 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
771 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
772 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
773 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
774 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
775 {
776 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
777
778 if (sb_width > 0)
779 {
780 int left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
781 int width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
782 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
783
784 if (bx < 0)
785 {
786 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
787 if (left + width == p->x)
788 bx = left + sb_width;
789 else if (p->x + p->wd == left)
790 bx = left;
791 if (bx >= 0)
792 {
793 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
794
795 nx = width - sb_width;
796 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
797 row->y));
798 ny = row->visible_height;
799 }
800 }
801 else
802 {
803 if (left + width == bx)
804 {
805 bx = left + sb_width;
806 nx += width - sb_width;
807 }
808 else if (bx + nx == left)
809 nx += width - sb_width;
810 }
811 }
812 }
813 #endif
814 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
815 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
816
817 if (!face->stipple)
818 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
819 }
820
821 if (p->which)
822 {
823 unsigned char *bits;
824 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
825 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
826 XGCValues gcv;
827
828 if (p->wd > 8)
829 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
830 else
831 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
832
833 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
834 by the server. */
835 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
836 (p->cursor_p
837 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
838 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
839 : face->foreground),
840 face->background, depth);
841
842 if (p->overlay_p)
843 {
844 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
845 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
846 bits, p->wd, p->h,
847 1, 0, 1);
848 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
849 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
850 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
851 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
852 }
853
854 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
855 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
856 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
857
858 if (p->overlay_p)
859 {
860 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
861 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
862 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
863 }
864 }
865
866 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
867 }
868
869 \f
870
871 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
872 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
873 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
874 rarely happens). */
875
876 static void
877 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
878 {
879 }
880
881 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
882 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
883
884 static void
885 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
886 {
887 }
888
889 \f
890 /***********************************************************************
891 Glyph display
892 ***********************************************************************/
893
894
895
896 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
897 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
898 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
899 int);
900 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
901 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
902 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
903 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
904 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
905 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
906 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
907 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
908 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
909 unsigned long *, double, int);
910 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
911 double, int, unsigned long);
912 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
913 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
914 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
915 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
916 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
917 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
918 int, int, int);
919 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
920 int, int, int, int, int, int,
921 XRectangle *);
922 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
923 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
924 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
925
926 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
927 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
928 #endif
929
930
931 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
932 face. */
933
934 static void
935 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
936 {
937 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
938 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
939 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
940 && !s->cmp)
941 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
942 else
943 {
944 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
945 XGCValues xgcv;
946 unsigned long mask;
947
948 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
949 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
950
951 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
952 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
953 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
954 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
955 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
956 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
957 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
958
959 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
960 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
961 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
962 {
963 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
964 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
965 }
966
967 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
968 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
969 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
970
971 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
972 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
973 mask, &xgcv);
974 else
975 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
976 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
977
978 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
979 }
980 }
981
982
983 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
984
985 static void
986 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
987 {
988 int face_id;
989 struct face *face;
990
991 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
992 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
993 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
994 if (face == NULL)
995 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
996
997 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
998 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
999 else
1000 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1001 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1002 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1003
1004 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1005 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1006 else
1007 {
1008 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1009 except for FONT. */
1010 XGCValues xgcv;
1011 unsigned long mask;
1012
1013 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1014 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1015 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1016 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1017
1018 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1019 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1020 mask, &xgcv);
1021 else
1022 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1023 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1024
1025 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1026
1027 }
1028 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1029 }
1030
1031
1032 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1033 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1034 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1035
1036 static INLINE void
1037 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1038 {
1039 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1040 }
1041
1042
1043 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1044 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1045 pattern. */
1046
1047 static INLINE void
1048 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1049 {
1050 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1051
1052 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1053 {
1054 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1055 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1056 }
1057 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1058 {
1059 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1060 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1061 }
1062 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1063 {
1064 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1065 s->stippled_p = 0;
1066 }
1067 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1068 {
1069 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1070 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1071 }
1072 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1073 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1074 {
1075 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1076 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1077 }
1078 else
1079 {
1080 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1081 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1082 }
1083
1084 /* GC must have been set. */
1085 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1086 }
1087
1088
1089 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1090 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1091
1092 static INLINE void
1093 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1094 {
1095 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1096 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1097
1098 if (n > 0)
1099 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1100 s->num_clips = n;
1101 }
1102
1103
1104 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1105 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1106 the area of SRC. */
1107
1108 static void
1109 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1110 {
1111 XRectangle r;
1112
1113 r.x = src->x;
1114 r.width = src->width;
1115 r.y = src->y;
1116 r.height = src->height;
1117 dst->clip[0] = r;
1118 dst->num_clips = 1;
1119 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1120 }
1121
1122
1123 /* RIF:
1124 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1125
1126 static void
1127 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1128 {
1129 if (s->cmp == NULL
1130 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1131 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1132 {
1133 struct font_metrics metrics;
1134
1135 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1136 {
1137 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1138 struct font *font = s->font;
1139 int i;
1140
1141 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1142 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1143 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1144 }
1145 else
1146 {
1147 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1148
1149 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1150 }
1151 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1152 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1153 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1154 }
1155 else if (s->cmp)
1156 {
1157 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1158 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1159 }
1160 }
1161
1162
1163 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1164
1165 static INLINE void
1166 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1167 {
1168 XGCValues xgcv;
1169 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1170 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1171 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1172 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1173 }
1174
1175
1176 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1177 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1178 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1179 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1180 contains the first component of a composition. */
1181
1182 static void
1183 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1184 {
1185 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1186 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1187 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1188 {
1189 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1190
1191 if (s->stippled_p)
1192 {
1193 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1194 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1195 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1196 s->y + box_line_width,
1197 s->background_width,
1198 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1199 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1200 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1201 }
1202 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1203 || s->font_not_found_p
1204 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1205 || force_p)
1206 {
1207 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1208 s->background_width,
1209 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1210 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1211 }
1212 }
1213 }
1214
1215
1216 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1217
1218 static void
1219 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1220 {
1221 int i, x;
1222
1223 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1224 of S to the right of that box line. */
1225 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1226 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1227 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1228 else
1229 x = s->x;
1230
1231 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1232 loaded. */
1233 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1234 {
1235 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1236 {
1237 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1238 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1239 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1240 s->height - 1);
1241 x += g->pixel_width;
1242 }
1243 }
1244 else
1245 {
1246 struct font *font = s->font;
1247 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1248 int y;
1249
1250 if (font->vertical_centering)
1251 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1252
1253 y = s->ybase - boff;
1254 if (s->for_overlaps
1255 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1256 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1257 else
1258 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1259 if (s->face->overstrike)
1260 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1261 }
1262 }
1263
1264 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1265
1266 static void
1267 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1268 {
1269 int i, j, x;
1270 struct font *font = s->font;
1271
1272 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1273 of S to the right of that box line. */
1274 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1275 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1276 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1277 else
1278 x = s->x;
1279
1280 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1281 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1282 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1283 this composition. */
1284
1285 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1286 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1287 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1288 {
1289 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1290 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1291 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1292 }
1293 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1294 {
1295 int y = s->ybase;
1296
1297 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1298 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1299 {
1300 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1301 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1302
1303 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1304 if (s->face->overstrike)
1305 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1306 }
1307 }
1308 else
1309 {
1310 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1311 Lisp_Object glyph;
1312 int y = s->ybase;
1313 int width = 0;
1314
1315 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1316 {
1317 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1318 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1319 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1320 else
1321 {
1322 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1323
1324 if (j < i)
1325 {
1326 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1327 if (s->face->overstrike)
1328 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1329 x += width;
1330 }
1331 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1332 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1333 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1334 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1335 if (s->face->overstrike)
1336 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1337 x += wadjust;
1338 j = i + 1;
1339 width = 0;
1340 }
1341 }
1342 if (j < i)
1343 {
1344 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1345 if (s->face->overstrike)
1346 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1347 }
1348 }
1349 }
1350
1351
1352 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1353
1354 static void
1355 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1356 {
1357 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1358 XChar2b char2b[8];
1359 int x, i, j;
1360
1361 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1362 of S to the right of that box line. */
1363 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1364 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1365 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1366 else
1367 x = s->x;
1368
1369 s->char2b = char2b;
1370
1371 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1372 {
1373 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1374 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1375
1376 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1377 {
1378 if (len > 0
1379 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1380 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1381 >= 1))
1382 {
1383 Lisp_Object acronym
1384 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1385 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1386 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1387 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1388 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1389 str = (char *) SDATA (acronym);
1390 }
1391 }
1392 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1393 {
1394 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1395 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1396 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1397 str = buf;
1398 }
1399
1400 if (str)
1401 {
1402 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1403 unsigned code;
1404
1405 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1406 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1407 {
1408 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1409 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1410 }
1411 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1412 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1413 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1414 0);
1415 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1416 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1417 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1418 0);
1419 }
1420 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1421 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1422 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1423 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1424 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1425 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1426 }
1427 }
1428
1429 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1430
1431 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1432 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1433 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1434 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1435 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1436
1437
1438 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1439 cannot be determined. */
1440
1441 static struct frame *
1442 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1443 {
1444 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1445 Lisp_Object tail;
1446 struct frame *f;
1447
1448 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1449
1450 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1451 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1452 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1453 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1454 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1455 widget = XtParent (widget);
1456
1457 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1458 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1459 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1460 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1461 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1462 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1463 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1464 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1465 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1466 return f;
1467
1468 abort ();
1469 }
1470
1471
1472 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1473 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1474 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1475 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1476
1477 int
1478 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1479 {
1480 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1481 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1482 }
1483
1484
1485 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1486 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1487 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1488 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1489 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1490 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1491
1492 int
1493 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1494 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1495 {
1496 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1497 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1498 }
1499
1500
1501 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1502 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1503
1504 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1505 {
1506 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1507 sizeof (Screen *)},
1508 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1509 sizeof (Colormap)}
1510 };
1511
1512
1513 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1514 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1515
1516 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1517
1518
1519 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1520
1521 DPY is the display we are working on.
1522
1523 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1524 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1525 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1526 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1527
1528 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1529 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1530
1531 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1532 we allocated the color or not.
1533
1534 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1535
1536 static Boolean
1537 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1538 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1539 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1540 {
1541 Screen *screen;
1542 Colormap cmap;
1543 Pixel pixel;
1544 String color_name;
1545 XColor color;
1546
1547 if (*nargs != 2)
1548 {
1549 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1550 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1551 "XtToolkitError",
1552 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1553 return False;
1554 }
1555
1556 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1557 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1558 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1559
1560 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1561 {
1562 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1563 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1564 }
1565 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1566 {
1567 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1568 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1569 }
1570 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1571 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1572 {
1573 pixel = color.pixel;
1574 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1575 }
1576 else
1577 {
1578 String params[1];
1579 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1580
1581 params[0] = color_name;
1582 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1583 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1584 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1585 params, &nparams);
1586 return False;
1587 }
1588
1589 if (to->addr != NULL)
1590 {
1591 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1592 {
1593 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1594 return False;
1595 }
1596
1597 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1598 }
1599 else
1600 {
1601 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1602 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1603 }
1604
1605 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1606 return True;
1607 }
1608
1609
1610 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1611 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1612 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1613
1614 APP is the application context in which we work.
1615
1616 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1617 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1618 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1619
1620 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1621
1622 static void
1623 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1624 Cardinal *nargs)
1625 {
1626 if (*nargs != 2)
1627 {
1628 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1629 "XtToolkitError",
1630 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1631 NULL, NULL);
1632 }
1633 else if (closure != NULL)
1634 {
1635 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1636 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1637 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1638 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1639 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1640 }
1641 }
1642
1643
1644 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1645
1646
1647 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1648 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1649 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1650 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1651
1652 static const XColor *
1653 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1654 {
1655 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1656
1657 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1658 {
1659 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1660 int i;
1661
1662 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1663 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1664 dpyinfo->color_cells
1665 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1666 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1667
1668 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1669 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1670
1671 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1672 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1673 }
1674
1675 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1676 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1677 }
1678
1679
1680 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1681 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1682
1683 void
1684 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1685 {
1686 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1687
1688 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1689 {
1690 int i;
1691 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1692 {
1693 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1694 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1695 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1696 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1697 }
1698 }
1699 else
1700 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1701 }
1702
1703
1704 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1705 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1706
1707 void
1708 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1709 {
1710 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1711 }
1712
1713
1714 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1715 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1716 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1717 allocated. */
1718
1719 static int
1720 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1721 {
1722 int rc;
1723
1724 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1725 if (rc == 0)
1726 {
1727 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1728 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1729 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1730 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1731 int nearest, i;
1732 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1733 int ncells;
1734 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1735
1736 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1737 {
1738 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1739 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1740 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1741 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1742
1743 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1744 {
1745 nearest = i;
1746 nearest_delta = delta;
1747 }
1748 }
1749
1750 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1751 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1752 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1753 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1754 }
1755 else
1756 {
1757 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1758 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1759 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1760 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1761 XColor *cached_color;
1762
1763 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1764 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1765 (cached_color->red != color->red
1766 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1767 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1768 {
1769 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1770 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1771 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1772 }
1773 }
1774
1775 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1776 if (rc)
1777 register_color (color->pixel);
1778 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1779
1780 return rc;
1781 }
1782
1783
1784 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1785 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1786 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1787 allocated. */
1788
1789 int
1790 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1791 {
1792 gamma_correct (f, color);
1793 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1794 }
1795
1796
1797 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1798 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1799 get color reference counts right. */
1800
1801 unsigned long
1802 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1803 {
1804 XColor color;
1805
1806 color.pixel = pixel;
1807 BLOCK_INPUT;
1808 x_query_color (f, &color);
1809 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1810 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1811 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1812 register_color (pixel);
1813 #endif
1814 return color.pixel;
1815 }
1816
1817
1818 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1819 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1820 get color reference counts right. */
1821
1822 unsigned long
1823 x_copy_dpy_color (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int pixel)
1824 {
1825 XColor color;
1826
1827 color.pixel = pixel;
1828 BLOCK_INPUT;
1829 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1830 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1831 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1832 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1833 register_color (pixel);
1834 #endif
1835 return color.pixel;
1836 }
1837
1838
1839 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1840 boosted.
1841
1842 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1843 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1844 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1845 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1846 use an additional additive factor.
1847
1848 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1849 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1850 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1851
1852
1853 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1854 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1855 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1856 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1857 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1858 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1859
1860 static int
1861 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1862 {
1863 XColor color, new;
1864 long bright;
1865 int success_p;
1866
1867 /* Get RGB color values. */
1868 color.pixel = *pixel;
1869 x_query_color (f, &color);
1870
1871 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1872 xassert (factor >= 0);
1873 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1874 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1875 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1876
1877 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1878 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1879
1880 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1881 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1882 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1883 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1884 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1885 {
1886 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1887 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1888 /* The additive adjustment. */
1889 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1890
1891 if (factor < 1)
1892 {
1893 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1894 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1895 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1896 }
1897 else
1898 {
1899 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1900 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1901 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1902 }
1903 }
1904
1905 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1906 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1907 if (success_p)
1908 {
1909 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1910 {
1911 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1912 delta to the RGB values. */
1913 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1914
1915 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1916 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1917 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1918 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1919 }
1920 else
1921 success_p = 1;
1922 *pixel = new.pixel;
1923 }
1924
1925 return success_p;
1926 }
1927
1928
1929 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1930 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1931 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1932 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1933 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1934 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1935
1936 static void
1937 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1938 {
1939 XGCValues xgcv;
1940 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1941 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1942 unsigned long pixel;
1943 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1944 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1945 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1946 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1947
1948 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1949 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1950
1951 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1952 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1953 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1954 if (relief->gc
1955 && relief->allocated_p)
1956 {
1957 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1958 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1959 }
1960
1961 /* Allocate new color. */
1962 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1963 pixel = background;
1964 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1965 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1966 {
1967 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1968 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1969 }
1970
1971 if (relief->gc == 0)
1972 {
1973 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1974 mask |= GCStipple;
1975 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1976 }
1977 else
1978 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1979 }
1980
1981
1982 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1983
1984 static void
1985 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1986 {
1987 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1988 unsigned long color;
1989
1990 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1991 color = s->face->box_color;
1992 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1993 && s->img->pixmap
1994 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1995 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1996 else
1997 {
1998 XGCValues xgcv;
1999
2000 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2001 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2002 color = xgcv.background;
2003 }
2004
2005 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2006 || color != di->relief_background)
2007 {
2008 di->relief_background = color;
2009 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2010 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2011 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2012 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2013 }
2014 }
2015
2016
2017 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2018 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2019 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2020 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2021 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2022 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2023 when drawing. */
2024
2025 static void
2026 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
2027 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2028 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
2029 XRectangle *clip_rect)
2030 {
2031 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2032 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2033 int i;
2034 GC gc;
2035
2036 if (raised_p)
2037 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2038 else
2039 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2040 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2041
2042 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2043 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2044 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2045 corner pixels. */
2046
2047 /* Top. */
2048 if (top_p)
2049 {
2050 if (width == 1)
2051 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2052 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2053 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2054
2055 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2056 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2057 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2058 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2059 }
2060
2061 /* Left. */
2062 if (left_p)
2063 {
2064 if (width == 1)
2065 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2066
2067 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2068 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2069
2070 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2071 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2072 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2073 }
2074
2075 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2076 if (raised_p)
2077 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2078 else
2079 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2080 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2081
2082 if (width > 1)
2083 {
2084 /* Outermost top line. */
2085 if (top_p)
2086 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2087 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2088 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2089
2090 /* Outermost left line. */
2091 if (left_p)
2092 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2093 }
2094
2095 /* Bottom. */
2096 if (bot_p)
2097 {
2098 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2099 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2100 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2101 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2102 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2103 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2104 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2105 }
2106
2107 /* Right. */
2108 if (right_p)
2109 {
2110 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2111 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2112 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2113 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2114 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2115 }
2116
2117 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2118 }
2119
2120
2121 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2122 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2123 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2124 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2125 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2126 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2127
2128 static void
2129 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2130 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2131 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2132 {
2133 XGCValues xgcv;
2134
2135 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2136 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2137 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2138
2139 /* Top. */
2140 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2141 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2142
2143 /* Left. */
2144 if (left_p)
2145 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2146 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2147
2148 /* Bottom. */
2149 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2150 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2151
2152 /* Right. */
2153 if (right_p)
2154 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2155 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2156
2157 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2158 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2159 }
2160
2161
2162 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2163
2164 static void
2165 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2166 {
2167 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2168 int left_p, right_p;
2169 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2170 XRectangle clip_rect;
2171
2172 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2173 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2174 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2175
2176 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2177 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2178 ? s->first_glyph
2179 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2180
2181 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2182 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2183 left_x = s->x;
2184 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2185 ? last_x - 1
2186 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2187 top_y = s->y;
2188 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2189
2190 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2191 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2192 && (s->prev == NULL
2193 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2194 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2195 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2196 && (s->next == NULL
2197 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2198
2199 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2200
2201 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2202 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2203 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2204 else
2205 {
2206 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2207 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2208 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2209 }
2210 }
2211
2212
2213 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2214
2215 static void
2216 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2217 {
2218 int x = s->x;
2219 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2220
2221 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2222 right of that line. */
2223 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2224 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2225 && s->slice.x == 0)
2226 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2227
2228 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2229 by that margin. */
2230 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2231 x += s->img->hmargin;
2232 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2233 y += s->img->vmargin;
2234
2235 if (s->img->pixmap)
2236 {
2237 if (s->img->mask)
2238 {
2239 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2240 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2241 trust on the shape extension to be available
2242 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2243 manually. */
2244 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2245 | GCFunction);
2246 XGCValues xgcv;
2247 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2248
2249 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2250 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2251 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2252 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2253 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2254
2255 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2256 image_rect.x = x;
2257 image_rect.y = y;
2258 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2259 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2260 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2261 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2262 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2263 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2264 }
2265 else
2266 {
2267 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2268
2269 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2270 image_rect.x = x;
2271 image_rect.y = y;
2272 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2273 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2274 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2275 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2276 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2277 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2278
2279 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2280 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2281 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2282 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2283 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2284 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2285 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2286 {
2287 int r = s->img->relief;
2288 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2289 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2290 x - r, y - r,
2291 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2292 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2293 }
2294 }
2295 }
2296 else
2297 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2298 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2299 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2300 }
2301
2302
2303 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2304
2305 static void
2306 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2307 {
2308 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, extra;
2309 XRectangle r;
2310 int x = s->x;
2311 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2312
2313 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2314 right of that line. */
2315 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2316 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2317 && s->slice.x == 0)
2318 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2319
2320 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2321 by that margin. */
2322 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2323 x += s->img->hmargin;
2324 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2325 y += s->img->vmargin;
2326
2327 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2328 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2329 {
2330 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2331 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2332 }
2333 else
2334 {
2335 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2336 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2337 }
2338
2339 extra = s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2340 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) : 0;
2341
2342 x0 = x - thick - extra;
2343 y0 = y - thick - extra;
2344 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra;
2345 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra;
2346
2347 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2348 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2349 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2350 s->slice.y == 0,
2351 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2352 s->slice.x == 0,
2353 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2354 &r);
2355 }
2356
2357
2358 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2359
2360 static void
2361 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2362 {
2363 int x = 0;
2364 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2365
2366 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2367 right of that line. */
2368 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2369 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2370 && s->slice.x == 0)
2371 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2372
2373 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2374 by that margin. */
2375 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2376 x += s->img->hmargin;
2377 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2378 y += s->img->vmargin;
2379
2380 if (s->img->pixmap)
2381 {
2382 if (s->img->mask)
2383 {
2384 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2385 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2386 trust on the shape extension to be available
2387 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2388 manually. */
2389 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2390 | GCFunction);
2391 XGCValues xgcv;
2392
2393 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2394 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2395 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2396 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2397 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2398
2399 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2400 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2401 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2402 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2403 }
2404 else
2405 {
2406 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2407 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2408 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2409
2410 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2411 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2412 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2413 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2414 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2415 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2416 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2417 {
2418 int r = s->img->relief;
2419 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2420 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2421 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2422 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2423 }
2424 }
2425 }
2426 else
2427 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2428 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2429 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2430 }
2431
2432
2433 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2434 give the rectangle to draw. */
2435
2436 static void
2437 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2438 {
2439 if (s->stippled_p)
2440 {
2441 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2442 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2443 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2444 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2445 }
2446 else
2447 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2448 }
2449
2450
2451 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2452
2453 s->y
2454 s->x +-------------------------
2455 | s->face->box
2456 |
2457 | +-------------------------
2458 | | s->img->margin
2459 | |
2460 | | +-------------------
2461 | | | the image
2462
2463 */
2464
2465 static void
2466 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2467 {
2468 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2469 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2470 int height;
2471 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2472
2473 height = s->height;
2474 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2475 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2476 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2477 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2478
2479 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2480 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2481 flickering. */
2482 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2483 if (height > s->slice.height
2484 || s->img->hmargin
2485 || s->img->vmargin
2486 || s->img->mask
2487 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2488 || s->width != s->background_width)
2489 {
2490 if (s->img->mask)
2491 {
2492 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2493 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2494 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2495 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2496 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2497
2498 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2499 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2500 s->background_width,
2501 s->height, depth);
2502
2503 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2504 pixmap. */
2505 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2506
2507 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2508 if (s->stippled_p)
2509 {
2510 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2511 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2512 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2513 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2514 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2515 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2516 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2517 }
2518 else
2519 {
2520 XGCValues xgcv;
2521 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2522 &xgcv);
2523 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2524 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2525 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2526 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2527 }
2528 }
2529 else
2530 {
2531 int x = s->x;
2532 int y = s->y;
2533
2534 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2535 && s->slice.x == 0)
2536 x += box_line_hwidth;
2537
2538 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2539 y += box_line_vwidth;
2540
2541 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2542 }
2543
2544 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2545 }
2546
2547 /* Draw the foreground. */
2548 if (pixmap != None)
2549 {
2550 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2551 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2552 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2553 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2554 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2555 }
2556 else
2557 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2558
2559 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2560 if (s->img->relief
2561 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2562 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2563 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2564 }
2565
2566
2567 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2568
2569 static void
2570 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2571 {
2572 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2573
2574 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2575 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2576 {
2577 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2578 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2579 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2580 int x = s->x;
2581
2582 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2583 {
2584 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2585
2586 if (x < left_x)
2587 {
2588 background_width -= left_x - x;
2589 x = left_x;
2590 }
2591 }
2592 else
2593 {
2594 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2595 stretch glyph. */
2596 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2597
2598 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2599 background_width -= x - right_x;
2600 x += background_width;
2601 }
2602 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2603 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2604 x -= width;
2605
2606 /* Draw cursor. */
2607 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2608
2609 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2610 if (width < background_width)
2611 {
2612 int y = s->y;
2613 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2614 XRectangle r;
2615 GC gc;
2616
2617 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2618 x += width;
2619 else
2620 x = s->x;
2621 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2622 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2623 {
2624 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2625 gc = s->gc;
2626 }
2627 else
2628 gc = s->face->gc;
2629
2630 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2631 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2632
2633 if (s->face->stipple)
2634 {
2635 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2636 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2637 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2638 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2639 }
2640 else
2641 {
2642 XGCValues xgcv;
2643 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2644 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2645 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2646 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2647 }
2648 }
2649 }
2650 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2651 {
2652 int background_width = s->background_width;
2653 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2654
2655 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2656 except for header line and mode line. */
2657 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2658 {
2659 background_width -= left_x - x;
2660 x = left_x;
2661 }
2662 if (background_width > 0)
2663 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2664 }
2665
2666 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2667 }
2668
2669
2670 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2671
2672 static void
2673 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2674 {
2675 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2676
2677 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2678 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2679 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2680 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2681 {
2682 int width;
2683 struct glyph_string *next;
2684
2685 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2686 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2687 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2688 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2689 {
2690 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2691 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2692 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2693 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2694 else
2695 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2696 next->num_clips = 0;
2697 }
2698 }
2699
2700 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2701 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2702
2703 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2704 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2705 if (!s->for_overlaps
2706 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2707 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2708 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2709
2710 {
2711 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2712 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2713 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2714 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2715 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2716 }
2717 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2718 && !s->clip_tail
2719 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2720 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2721 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2722 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2723 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2724 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2725 else
2726 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2727
2728 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2729 {
2730 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2731 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2732 break;
2733
2734 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2735 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2736 break;
2737
2738 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2739 if (s->for_overlaps)
2740 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2741 else
2742 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2743 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2744 break;
2745
2746 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2747 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2748 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2749 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2750 else
2751 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2752 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2753 break;
2754
2755 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2756 if (s->for_overlaps)
2757 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2758 else
2759 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2760 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2761 break;
2762
2763 default:
2764 abort ();
2765 }
2766
2767 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2768 {
2769 /* Draw underline. */
2770 if (s->face->underline_p)
2771 {
2772 unsigned long thickness, position;
2773 int y;
2774
2775 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2776 {
2777 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2778 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2779 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2780 }
2781 else
2782 {
2783 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2784 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2785 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2786 else
2787 thickness = 1;
2788 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2789 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2790 else
2791 {
2792 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2793 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2794 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2795 specs, and its default is
2796
2797 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2798 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2799
2800 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2801 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2802 position = s->font->underline_position;
2803 else if (s->font)
2804 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2805 else
2806 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2807 }
2808 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2809 }
2810 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2811 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2812 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2813 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2814 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2815 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2816 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2817 s->underline_position = position;
2818 y = s->ybase + position;
2819 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2820 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2821 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2822 else
2823 {
2824 XGCValues xgcv;
2825 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2826 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2827 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2828 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2829 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2830 }
2831 }
2832
2833 /* Draw overline. */
2834 if (s->face->overline_p)
2835 {
2836 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2837
2838 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2839 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2840 s->width, h);
2841 else
2842 {
2843 XGCValues xgcv;
2844 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2845 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2846 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2847 s->width, h);
2848 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2849 }
2850 }
2851
2852 /* Draw strike-through. */
2853 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2854 {
2855 unsigned long h = 1;
2856 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2857
2858 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2859 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2860 s->width, h);
2861 else
2862 {
2863 XGCValues xgcv;
2864 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2865 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2866 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2867 s->width, h);
2868 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2869 }
2870 }
2871
2872 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2873 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2874 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2875
2876 if (s->prev)
2877 {
2878 struct glyph_string *prev;
2879
2880 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2881 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2882 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2883 {
2884 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2885 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2886 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2887
2888 prev->hl = s->hl;
2889 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2890 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2891 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2892 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2893 else
2894 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2895 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2896 prev->hl = save;
2897 prev->num_clips = 0;
2898 }
2899 }
2900
2901 if (s->next)
2902 {
2903 struct glyph_string *next;
2904
2905 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2906 if (next->hl != s->hl
2907 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2908 {
2909 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2910 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2911 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2912
2913 next->hl = s->hl;
2914 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2915 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2916 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2917 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2918 else
2919 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2920 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2921 next->hl = save;
2922 next->num_clips = 0;
2923 }
2924 }
2925 }
2926
2927 /* Reset clipping. */
2928 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2929 s->num_clips = 0;
2930 }
2931
2932 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2933
2934 void
2935 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2936 {
2937 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2938 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2939 x, y, width, height,
2940 x + shift_by, y);
2941 }
2942
2943 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2944 for X frames. */
2945
2946 static void
2947 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2948 {
2949 abort ();
2950 }
2951
2952
2953 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2954 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2955
2956 void
2957 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2958 {
2959 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2960 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2961 }
2962
2963
2964 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2965
2966 static void
2967 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2968 {
2969 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2970 longer visible. */
2971 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2972 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2973 output_cursor.x = -1;
2974
2975 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2976 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2977 BLOCK_INPUT;
2978 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2979
2980 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2981 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2982 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2983
2984 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2985 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2986 redisplay, do it here. */
2987 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2988 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2989 #endif
2990
2991 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2992
2993 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2994 }
2995
2996
2997 \f
2998 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2999
3000 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
3001 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
3002
3003 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3004
3005
3006 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
3007 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
3008
3009 static int
3010 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
3011 {
3012 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
3013 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
3014 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
3015 {
3016 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
3017 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
3018 y.tv_sec += nsec;
3019 }
3020
3021 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
3022 {
3023 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
3024 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
3025 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
3026 }
3027
3028 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
3029 positive. */
3030 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
3031 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
3032
3033 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
3034 negative. */
3035 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
3036 }
3037
3038 void
3039 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3040 {
3041 BLOCK_INPUT;
3042
3043 {
3044 #ifdef USE_GTK
3045 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3046 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3047 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3048 GdkGCValues vals;
3049 GdkGC *gc;
3050 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3051 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3052 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3053 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3054 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3055 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3056 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3057 #else
3058 GC gc;
3059
3060 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3061 pixels into background pixels. */
3062 {
3063 XGCValues values;
3064
3065 values.function = GXxor;
3066 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3067 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3068
3069 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3070 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3071 }
3072 #endif
3073 {
3074 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3075 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3076 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3077 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3078 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3079 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3080 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3081
3082 int width;
3083
3084 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3085 edge it is next to. */
3086 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3087 {
3088 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3089 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3090 break;
3091
3092 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3093 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3094 break;
3095
3096 default:
3097 break;
3098 }
3099
3100 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3101
3102 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3103 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3104 {
3105 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3106 flash_left,
3107 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3108 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3109 width, flash_height);
3110 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3111 flash_left,
3112 (height - flash_height
3113 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3114 width, flash_height);
3115
3116 }
3117 else
3118 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3119 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3120 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3121 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3122
3123 x_flush (f);
3124
3125 {
3126 struct timeval wakeup;
3127
3128 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3129
3130 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3131 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3132 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3133 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3134
3135 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3136 available. */
3137 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3138 {
3139 struct timeval current;
3140 struct timeval timeout;
3141
3142 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3143
3144 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3145 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3146 break;
3147
3148 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3149 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3150 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3151
3152 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3153 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3154 }
3155 }
3156
3157 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3158 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3159 {
3160 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3161 flash_left,
3162 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3163 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3164 width, flash_height);
3165 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3166 flash_left,
3167 (height - flash_height
3168 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3169 width, flash_height);
3170 }
3171 else
3172 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3173 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3174 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3175 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3176
3177 #ifdef USE_GTK
3178 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3179 #undef XFillRectangle
3180 #else
3181 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3182 #endif
3183 x_flush (f);
3184 }
3185 }
3186
3187 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3188 }
3189
3190 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3191
3192
3193 static void
3194 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3195 {
3196 BLOCK_INPUT;
3197 if (invisible)
3198 {
3199 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3200 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3201 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3202 }
3203 else
3204 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3205 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3206 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3207 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3208 }
3209
3210
3211 /* Make audible bell. */
3212
3213 void
3214 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3215 {
3216 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3217 {
3218 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3219 if (visible_bell)
3220 XTflash (f);
3221 else
3222 #endif
3223 {
3224 BLOCK_INPUT;
3225 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3226 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3227 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3228 }
3229 }
3230 }
3231
3232 \f
3233 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3234 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3235 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3236 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3237
3238 static void
3239 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3240 {
3241 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3242 }
3243
3244
3245 \f
3246 /***********************************************************************
3247 Line Dance
3248 ***********************************************************************/
3249
3250 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3251 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3252
3253 static void
3254 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3255 {
3256 abort ();
3257 }
3258
3259
3260 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3261
3262 static void
3263 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3264 {
3265 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3266 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3267
3268 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3269 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3270 fringe of W. */
3271 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3272
3273 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3274 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3275 bottom_y = y + height;
3276
3277 if (to_y < from_y)
3278 {
3279 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3280 line at the bottom. */
3281 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3282 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3283 else
3284 height = run->height;
3285 }
3286 else
3287 {
3288 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3289 at the bottom. */
3290 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3291 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3292 else
3293 height = run->height;
3294 }
3295
3296 BLOCK_INPUT;
3297
3298 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3299 updated_window = w;
3300 x_clear_cursor (w);
3301
3302 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3303 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3304 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3305 x, from_y,
3306 width, height,
3307 x, to_y);
3308
3309 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3310 }
3311
3312
3313 \f
3314 /***********************************************************************
3315 Exposure Events
3316 ***********************************************************************/
3317
3318 \f
3319 static void
3320 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3321 {
3322 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3323 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3324 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3325 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3326 BLOCK_INPUT;
3327 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3328 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3329 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3330 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3331 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3332 }
3333
3334 static void
3335 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3336 {
3337 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3338 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3339 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3340 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3341 BLOCK_INPUT;
3342 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3343 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3344 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3345 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3346 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3347 }
3348
3349 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3350 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3351 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3352 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3353 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3354
3355 static void
3356 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3357 {
3358 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3359
3360 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3361 {
3362 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3363 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3364 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3365
3366 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3367 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3368
3369 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3370 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3371 else
3372 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3373 }
3374
3375 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3376 }
3377
3378 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3379 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3380 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3381
3382 static void
3383 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3384 {
3385 if (type == FocusIn)
3386 {
3387 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3388 {
3389 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3390 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3391
3392 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3393 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3394 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3395 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3396 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3397 {
3398 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3399 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3400 }
3401 }
3402
3403 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3404
3405 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3406 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3407 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3408 #endif
3409 }
3410 else if (type == FocusOut)
3411 {
3412 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3413
3414 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3415 {
3416 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3417 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3418 }
3419
3420 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3421 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3422 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3423 #endif
3424 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3425 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3426 }
3427 }
3428
3429 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3430 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3431
3432 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3433
3434 static void
3435 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3436 {
3437 struct frame *frame;
3438
3439 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3440 if (! frame)
3441 return;
3442
3443 switch (event->type)
3444 {
3445 case EnterNotify:
3446 case LeaveNotify:
3447 {
3448 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3449 int focus_state
3450 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3451
3452 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3453 && event->xcrossing.focus
3454 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3455 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3456 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3457 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3458 }
3459 break;
3460
3461 case FocusIn:
3462 case FocusOut:
3463 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3464 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3465 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3466 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3467 break;
3468
3469 case ClientMessage:
3470 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3471 {
3472 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3473 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3474 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3475 }
3476 break;
3477 }
3478 }
3479
3480
3481 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3482
3483 void
3484 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3485 {
3486 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3487 }
3488
3489 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3490 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3491 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3492
3493 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3494 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3495 the appropriate X display info. */
3496
3497 static void
3498 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3499 {
3500 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3501 }
3502
3503 static void
3504 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3505 {
3506 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3507
3508 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3509 {
3510 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3511 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3512 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3513 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3514 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3515 {
3516 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3517 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3518 }
3519 }
3520 else
3521 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3522
3523 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3524 {
3525 if (old_highlight)
3526 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3527 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3528 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3529 }
3530 }
3531
3532
3533 \f
3534 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3535
3536 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3537 static void
3538 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3539 {
3540 int min_code, max_code;
3541 KeySym *syms;
3542 int syms_per_code;
3543 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3544
3545 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3546 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3547 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3548 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3549 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3550
3551 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3552
3553 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3554 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3555 &syms_per_code);
3556 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3557
3558 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3559 Alt keysyms are on. */
3560 {
3561 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3562 int found_alt_or_meta;
3563
3564 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3565 {
3566 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3567 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3568 {
3569 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3570
3571 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3572 if (code == 0)
3573 continue;
3574
3575 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3576 {
3577 int code_col;
3578
3579 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3580 {
3581 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3582
3583 switch (sym)
3584 {
3585 case XK_Meta_L:
3586 case XK_Meta_R:
3587 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3588 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3589 break;
3590
3591 case XK_Alt_L:
3592 case XK_Alt_R:
3593 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3594 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3595 break;
3596
3597 case XK_Hyper_L:
3598 case XK_Hyper_R:
3599 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3600 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3601 code_col = syms_per_code;
3602 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3603 break;
3604
3605 case XK_Super_L:
3606 case XK_Super_R:
3607 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3608 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3609 code_col = syms_per_code;
3610 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3611 break;
3612
3613 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3614 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3615 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3616 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3617 code_col = syms_per_code;
3618 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3619 break;
3620 }
3621 }
3622 }
3623 }
3624 }
3625 }
3626
3627 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3628 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3629 {
3630 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3631 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3632 }
3633
3634 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3635 make them just meta, not alt. */
3636 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3637 {
3638 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3639 }
3640
3641 XFree ((char *) syms);
3642 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3643 }
3644
3645 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3646 Emacs uses. */
3647
3648 unsigned int
3649 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3650 {
3651 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3652 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3653 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3654 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3655 Lisp_Object tem;
3656
3657 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3658 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3659 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3660 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3661 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3662 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3663 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3664 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3665
3666
3667 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3668 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3669 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3670 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3671 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3672 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3673 }
3674
3675 static unsigned int
3676 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3677 {
3678 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3679 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3680 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3681 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3682
3683 Lisp_Object tem;
3684
3685 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3686 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3687 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3688 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3689 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3690 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3691 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3692 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3693
3694
3695 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3696 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3697 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3698 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3699 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3700 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3701 }
3702
3703 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3704
3705 char *
3706 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3707 {
3708 char *value;
3709
3710 BLOCK_INPUT;
3711 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3712 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3713
3714 return value;
3715 }
3716
3717
3718 \f
3719 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3720
3721 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3722
3723 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3724 the mouse. */
3725
3726 static Lisp_Object
3727 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3728 {
3729 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3730 otherwise. */
3731 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3732 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3733 result->timestamp = event->time;
3734 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3735 event->state)
3736 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3737 ? up_modifier
3738 : down_modifier));
3739
3740 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3741 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3742 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3743 result->arg = Qnil;
3744 return Qnil;
3745 }
3746
3747 \f
3748 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3749 The input handler calls this.
3750
3751 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3752 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3753 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3754 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3755
3756 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3757 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3758
3759 static int
3760 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3761 {
3762 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3763 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3764 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3765
3766 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3767 return 0;
3768
3769 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3770 {
3771 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3772 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3773 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3774 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3775 return 1;
3776 }
3777
3778
3779 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3780 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3781 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3782 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3783 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3784 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3785 {
3786 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3787 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3788 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3789 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3790 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3791 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3792 return 1;
3793 }
3794
3795 return 0;
3796 }
3797
3798 \f
3799 /************************************************************************
3800 Mouse Face
3801 ************************************************************************/
3802
3803 static void
3804 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3805 {
3806 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3807 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3808 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3809 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3810 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3811 }
3812
3813
3814
3815 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3816 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3817
3818 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3819 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3820 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3821 position on the scroll bar.
3822
3823 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3824 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3825 the mouse is over.
3826
3827 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3828 was at this position.
3829
3830 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3831
3832 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3833 movement. */
3834
3835 static void
3836 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window, enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *time)
3837 {
3838 FRAME_PTR f1;
3839
3840 BLOCK_INPUT;
3841
3842 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3843 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3844 else
3845 {
3846 Window root;
3847 int root_x, root_y;
3848
3849 Window dummy_window;
3850 int dummy;
3851
3852 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3853
3854 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3855 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3856 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3857 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3858 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3859
3860 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3861
3862 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3863 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3864 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3865
3866 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3867 &root,
3868
3869 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3870 a different screen. */
3871 &dummy_window,
3872
3873 /* The position on that root window. */
3874 &root_x, &root_y,
3875
3876 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3877 &dummy, &dummy,
3878
3879 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3880 we don't care. */
3881 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3882
3883 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3884 containing the pointer. */
3885 {
3886 Window win, child;
3887 int win_x, win_y;
3888 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3889
3890 win = root;
3891
3892 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3893 structure is changing at the same time this function
3894 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3895
3896 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3897
3898 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3899 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3900 {
3901 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3902 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3903 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3904
3905 /* From-window, to-window. */
3906 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3907
3908 /* From-position, to-position. */
3909 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3910
3911 /* Child of win. */
3912 &child);
3913 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3914 }
3915 else
3916 {
3917 while (1)
3918 {
3919 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3920
3921 /* From-window, to-window. */
3922 root, win,
3923
3924 /* From-position, to-position. */
3925 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3926
3927 /* Child of win. */
3928 &child);
3929
3930 if (child == None || child == win)
3931 break;
3932 #ifdef USE_GTK
3933 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3934 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3935 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3936 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3937 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3938 break;
3939 #endif
3940 win = child;
3941 parent_x = win_x;
3942 parent_y = win_y;
3943 }
3944
3945 /* Now we know that:
3946 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3947 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3948 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3949 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3950 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3951 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3952 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3953 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3954 never use them in that case.) */
3955
3956 #ifdef USE_GTK
3957 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3958 want the edit window. */
3959 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3960 #else
3961 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3962 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3963 #endif
3964
3965 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3966 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3967 on the frame. */
3968 if (f1 != NULL
3969 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3970 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3971 f1 = NULL;
3972 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3973 }
3974
3975 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3976 f1 = 0;
3977
3978 x_uncatch_errors ();
3979
3980 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3981 if (! f1)
3982 {
3983 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3984
3985 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3986
3987 if (bar)
3988 {
3989 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3990 win_x = parent_x;
3991 win_y = parent_y;
3992 }
3993 }
3994
3995 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3996 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3997
3998 if (f1)
3999 {
4000 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4001 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4002 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4003 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4004 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4005 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4006 the frame are divided into. */
4007
4008 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4009 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4010
4011 *bar_window = Qnil;
4012 *part = 0;
4013 *fp = f1;
4014 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4015 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4016 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
4017 }
4018 }
4019 }
4020
4021 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4022 }
4023
4024
4025 \f
4026 /***********************************************************************
4027 Scroll bars
4028 ***********************************************************************/
4029
4030 /* Scroll bar support. */
4031
4032 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4033 manages it.
4034 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4035 bits. */
4036
4037 static struct scroll_bar *
4038 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4039 {
4040 Lisp_Object tail;
4041
4042 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4043 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4044 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4045
4046 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4047 {
4048 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4049
4050 frame = XCAR (tail);
4051 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4052 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4053 abort ();
4054
4055 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4056 continue;
4057
4058 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4059 right window ID. */
4060 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4061 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4062 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4063 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4064 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4065 condemned = Qnil,
4066 ! NILP (bar));
4067 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4068 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4069 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4070 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4071 }
4072
4073 return 0;
4074 }
4075
4076
4077 #if defined USE_LUCID
4078
4079 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4080 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4081
4082 static Widget
4083 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4084 {
4085 Lisp_Object tail;
4086
4087 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4088 {
4089 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4090 {
4091 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4092 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4093
4094 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4095 return menu_bar;
4096 }
4097 }
4098
4099 return NULL;
4100 }
4101
4102 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4103
4104 \f
4105 /************************************************************************
4106 Toolkit scroll bars
4107 ************************************************************************/
4108
4109 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4110
4111 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4112 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4113 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4114 struct scroll_bar *);
4115 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4116 int, int, int);
4117
4118
4119 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4120 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4121
4122 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4123
4124 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4125
4126 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4127
4128 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4129 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4130
4131 #ifndef USE_GTK
4132 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4133
4134 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4135
4136 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4137
4138 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4139 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4140 to avoid jerkyness. */
4141
4142 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4143
4144 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4145 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4146 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4147 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4148
4149 static void
4150 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4151 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4152 {
4153 int scroll_bar_p;
4154 const char *end_action;
4155
4156 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4157 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4158 end_action = "Release";
4159 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4160 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4161 end_action = "EndScroll";
4162 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4163
4164 if (scroll_bar_p
4165 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4166 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4167 {
4168 struct window *w;
4169
4170 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4171 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4172 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4173
4174 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4175 {
4176 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4177 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4178 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4179 }
4180 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4181 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4182
4183 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4184 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4185 }
4186 }
4187 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4188
4189 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4190 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4191
4192 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4193 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4194
4195
4196 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4197 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4198 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4199 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4200
4201 static void
4202 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4203 {
4204 XEvent event;
4205 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4206 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4207 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4208 int i;
4209
4210 BLOCK_INPUT;
4211
4212 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4213 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4214 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4215 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4216 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4217 ev->format = 32;
4218
4219 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4220 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4221 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4222 into that array in the event. */
4223 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4224 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4225 break;
4226
4227 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4228 {
4229 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4230 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4231 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4232
4233 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4234 nbytes);
4235 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4236 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4237 }
4238
4239 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4240 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4241 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4242 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4243 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4244 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4245
4246 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4247 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4248 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4249 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4250 #endif
4251
4252 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4253 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4254 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4255 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4256 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4257 }
4258
4259
4260 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4261 in *IEVENT. */
4262
4263 static void
4264 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4265 {
4266 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4267 Lisp_Object window;
4268 struct frame *f;
4269 struct window *w;
4270
4271 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4272 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4273
4274 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4275 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4276
4277 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4278 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4279 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4280 #ifdef USE_GTK
4281 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4282 #else
4283 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4284 #endif
4285 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4286 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4287 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4288 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4289 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4290 }
4291
4292
4293 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4294
4295 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4296
4297 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4298
4299
4300 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4301 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4302 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4303
4304 static void
4305 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4306 {
4307 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4308 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4309 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4310
4311 switch (cs->reason)
4312 {
4313 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4314 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4315 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4316 break;
4317
4318 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4319 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4320 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4321 break;
4322
4323 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4324 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4325 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4326 break;
4327
4328 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4329 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4330 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4331 break;
4332
4333 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4334 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4335 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4336 break;
4337
4338 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4339 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4340 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4341 break;
4342
4343 case XmCR_DRAG:
4344 {
4345 int slider_size;
4346
4347 /* Get the slider size. */
4348 BLOCK_INPUT;
4349 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4350 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4351
4352 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4353 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4354 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4355 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4356 }
4357 break;
4358
4359 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4360 break;
4361 };
4362
4363 if (part >= 0)
4364 {
4365 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4366 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4367 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4368 }
4369 }
4370
4371 #elif defined USE_GTK
4372
4373 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4374 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4375
4376 static gboolean
4377 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4378 GtkScrollType scroll,
4379 gdouble value,
4380 gpointer user_data)
4381 {
4382 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4383 gdouble position;
4384 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4385 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4386 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4387
4388 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4389 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4390
4391
4392 switch (scroll)
4393 {
4394 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4395 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4396 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4397 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4398 {
4399 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4400 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4401 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4402 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4403 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4404 }
4405 break;
4406 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4407 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4408 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4409 break;
4410 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4411 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4412 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4413 break;
4414 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4415 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4416 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4417 break;
4418 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4419 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4420 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4421 break;
4422 }
4423
4424 if (part >= 0)
4425 {
4426 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4427 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4428 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4429 }
4430
4431 return FALSE;
4432 }
4433
4434 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4435
4436 static gboolean
4437 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4438 GdkEventButton *event,
4439 gpointer user_data)
4440 {
4441 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4442 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4443 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4444 {
4445 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4446 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4447 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4448 }
4449
4450 return FALSE;
4451 }
4452
4453
4454 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4455
4456 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4457 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4458 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4459 the thumb is. */
4460
4461 static void
4462 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4463 {
4464 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4465 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4466 float shown;
4467 int whole, portion, height;
4468 int part;
4469
4470 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4471 BLOCK_INPUT;
4472 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4473 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4474
4475 whole = 10000000;
4476 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4477
4478 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4479 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4480 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4481 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4482 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4483 bottom). */
4484 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4485 else
4486 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4487
4488 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4489 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4490 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4491 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4492 }
4493
4494
4495 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4496 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4497 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4498 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4499 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4500 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4501 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4502
4503 static void
4504 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4505 {
4506 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4507 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4508 int position = (long) call_data;
4509 Dimension height;
4510 int part;
4511
4512 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4513 BLOCK_INPUT;
4514 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4515 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4516
4517 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4518 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4519
4520 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4521 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4522 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4523 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4524 else
4525 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4526
4527 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4528 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4529 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4530 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4531 }
4532
4533 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4534
4535 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4536
4537 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4538 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4539
4540 #ifdef USE_GTK
4541 static void
4542 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4543 {
4544 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4545
4546 BLOCK_INPUT;
4547 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4548 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4549 scroll_bar_name);
4550 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4551 }
4552
4553 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4554
4555 static void
4556 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4557 {
4558 Window xwindow;
4559 Widget widget;
4560 Arg av[20];
4561 int ac = 0;
4562 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4563 unsigned long pixel;
4564
4565 BLOCK_INPUT;
4566
4567 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4568 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4569 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4570 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4571 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4572 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4573 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4574 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4575 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4576
4577 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4578 if (pixel != -1)
4579 {
4580 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4581 ++ac;
4582 }
4583
4584 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4585 if (pixel != -1)
4586 {
4587 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4588 ++ac;
4589 }
4590
4591 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4592 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4593
4594 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4595 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4596 (XtPointer) bar);
4597 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4598 (XtPointer) bar);
4599 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4600 (XtPointer) bar);
4601 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4602 (XtPointer) bar);
4603 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4604 (XtPointer) bar);
4605 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4606 (XtPointer) bar);
4607 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4608 (XtPointer) bar);
4609
4610 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4611 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4612
4613 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4614 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4615 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4616 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4617
4618 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4619
4620 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4621 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4622 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4623 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4624 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4625 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4626 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4627 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4628
4629 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4630 if (pixel != -1)
4631 {
4632 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4633 ++ac;
4634 }
4635
4636 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4637 if (pixel != -1)
4638 {
4639 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4640 ++ac;
4641 }
4642
4643 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4644
4645 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4646 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4647 {
4648 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4649 if (pixel != -1)
4650 {
4651 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4652 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4653 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4654 pixel = -1;
4655 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4656 }
4657 }
4658 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4659 {
4660 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4661 if (pixel != -1)
4662 {
4663 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4664 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4665 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4666 pixel = -1;
4667 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4668 }
4669 }
4670
4671 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4672 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4673 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4674 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4675 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4676 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4677 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4678 colors itself. */
4679 {
4680 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4681 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4682 ++ac;
4683 }
4684 else
4685 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4686 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4687 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4688 {
4689 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4690 the shadows. */
4691 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4692 ++ac;
4693
4694 /* Specify the colors. */
4695 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4696 if (pixel != -1)
4697 {
4698 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4699 ++ac;
4700 }
4701 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4702 if (pixel != -1)
4703 {
4704 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4705 ++ac;
4706 }
4707 }
4708 #endif
4709
4710 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4711 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4712
4713 {
4714 char *initial = "";
4715 char *val = initial;
4716 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4717 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4718 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4719 #endif
4720 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4721 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4722 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4723 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4724 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4725 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4726 }
4727 }
4728
4729 /* Define callbacks. */
4730 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4731 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4732 (XtPointer) bar);
4733
4734 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4735 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4736
4737 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4738
4739 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4740 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4741 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4742 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4743
4744 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4745 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4746 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4747 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4748
4749 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4750 }
4751 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4752
4753
4754 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4755 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4756
4757 #ifdef USE_GTK
4758 static void
4759 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4760 {
4761 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4762 }
4763
4764 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4765 static void
4766 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4767 int whole)
4768 {
4769 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4770 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4771 float top, shown;
4772
4773 BLOCK_INPUT;
4774
4775 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4776
4777 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4778 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4779 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4780 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4781 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4782 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4783 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4784 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4785 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4786 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4787 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4788 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4789 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4790 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4791 whole += portion;
4792
4793 if (whole <= 0)
4794 top = 0, shown = 1;
4795 else
4796 {
4797 top = (float) position / whole;
4798 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4799 }
4800
4801 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4802 {
4803 int size, value;
4804
4805 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4806 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4807 value. */
4808 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4809 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4810 size = max (size, 1);
4811
4812 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4813 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4814 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4815
4816 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4817 }
4818 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4819
4820 if (whole == 0)
4821 top = 0, shown = 1;
4822 else
4823 {
4824 top = (float) position / whole;
4825 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4826 }
4827
4828 {
4829 float old_top, old_shown;
4830 Dimension height;
4831 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4832 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4833 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4834 XtNheight, &height,
4835 NULL);
4836
4837 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4838 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4839 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4840 else
4841 top = old_top;
4842 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4843 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4844
4845 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4846 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4847 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4848 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4849 {
4850 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4851 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4852 else
4853 {
4854 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4855 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4856 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4857
4858 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4859 }
4860 }
4861 }
4862 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4863
4864 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4865 }
4866 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4867
4868 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4869
4870
4871 \f
4872 /************************************************************************
4873 Scroll bars, general
4874 ************************************************************************/
4875
4876 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4877 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4878 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4879 scroll bar. */
4880
4881 static struct scroll_bar *
4882 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4883 {
4884 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4885 struct scroll_bar *bar
4886 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4887
4888 BLOCK_INPUT;
4889
4890 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4891 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4892 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4893 {
4894 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4895 unsigned long mask;
4896 Window window;
4897
4898 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4899 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4900 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4901
4902 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4903 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4904 | ExposureMask);
4905 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4906
4907 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4908
4909 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4910 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4911 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4912 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4913 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4914 left, top, width,
4915 window_box_height (w), False);
4916
4917 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4918 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4919 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4920 top,
4921 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4922 height,
4923 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4924 0,
4925 CopyFromParent,
4926 CopyFromParent,
4927 CopyFromParent,
4928 /* Attributes. */
4929 mask, &a);
4930 bar->x_window = window;
4931 }
4932 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4933
4934 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4935 bar->top = top;
4936 bar->left = left;
4937 bar->width = width;
4938 bar->height = height;
4939 bar->start = 0;
4940 bar->end = 0;
4941 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4942 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4943
4944 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4945 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4946 bar->prev = Qnil;
4947 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4948 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4949 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4950
4951 /* Map the window/widget. */
4952 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4953 {
4954 #ifdef USE_GTK
4955 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4956 bar->x_window,
4957 top,
4958 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4959 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4960 max (height, 1));
4961 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4962 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4963 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4964 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4965 top,
4966 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4967 max (height, 1), 0);
4968 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4969 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4970 }
4971 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4972 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
4973 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4974
4975 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4976 return bar;
4977 }
4978
4979
4980 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4981
4982 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4983
4984 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4985 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4986 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4987 events.)
4988
4989 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4990 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4991 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4992 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4993 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4994
4995 static void
4996 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
4997 {
4998 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4999 Window w = bar->x_window;
5000 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5001 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5002
5003 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5004 if (! rebuild
5005 && start == bar->start
5006 && end == bar->end)
5007 return;
5008
5009 BLOCK_INPUT;
5010
5011 {
5012 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5013 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5014 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5015
5016 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5017 the distance between start and end. */
5018 {
5019 int length = end - start;
5020
5021 if (start < 0)
5022 start = 0;
5023 else if (start > top_range)
5024 start = top_range;
5025 end = start + length;
5026
5027 if (end < start)
5028 end = start;
5029 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5030 end = top_range;
5031 }
5032
5033 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5034 bar->start = start;
5035 bar->end = end;
5036
5037 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5038 if (end > top_range)
5039 end = top_range;
5040
5041 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5042 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5043 that many pixels tall. */
5044 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5045
5046 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5047 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5048 if (0 < start)
5049 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5050 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5051 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5052 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5053 inside_width, start,
5054 False);
5055
5056 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5057 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5058 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5059 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5060
5061 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5062 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5063 /* x, y, width, height */
5064 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5065 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5066 inside_width, end - start);
5067
5068 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5069 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5070 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5071 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5072
5073 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5074 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5075 if (end < inside_height)
5076 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5077 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5078 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5079 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5080 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5081 False);
5082
5083 }
5084
5085 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5086 }
5087
5088 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5089
5090 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5091 nil. */
5092
5093 static void
5094 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5095 {
5096 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5097 BLOCK_INPUT;
5098
5099 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5100 #ifdef USE_GTK
5101 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5102 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5103 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5104 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5105 #else
5106 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5107 #endif
5108
5109 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5110 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5111
5112 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5113 }
5114
5115
5116 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5117 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5118 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5119 create one. */
5120
5121 static void
5122 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5123 {
5124 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5125 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5126 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5127 int window_y, window_height;
5128 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5129 int fringe_extended_p;
5130 #endif
5131
5132 /* Get window dimensions. */
5133 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5134 top = window_y;
5135 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5136 height = window_height;
5137
5138 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5139 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5140
5141 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5142 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5143 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5144 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5145 else
5146 sb_width = width;
5147
5148 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5149 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5150 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5151 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5152 else
5153 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5154 #else
5155 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5156 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5157 else
5158 sb_left = left;
5159 #endif
5160
5161 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5162 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5163 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5164 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5165 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5166 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5167 else
5168 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5169 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5170 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5171 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5172 #endif
5173
5174 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5175 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5176 {
5177 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5178 {
5179 BLOCK_INPUT;
5180 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5181 if (fringe_extended_p)
5182 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5183 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5184 else
5185 #endif
5186 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5187 left, top, width, height, False);
5188 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5189 }
5190
5191 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5192 }
5193 else
5194 {
5195 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5196 unsigned int mask = 0;
5197
5198 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5199
5200 BLOCK_INPUT;
5201
5202 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5203 mask |= CWX;
5204 if (top != bar->top)
5205 mask |= CWY;
5206 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5207 mask |= CWWidth;
5208 if (height != bar->height)
5209 mask |= CWHeight;
5210
5211 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5212
5213 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5214 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5215 {
5216 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5217 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5218 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5219 {
5220 if (fringe_extended_p)
5221 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5222 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5223 else
5224 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5225 left, top, width, height, False);
5226 }
5227 #ifdef USE_GTK
5228 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5229 bar->x_window,
5230 top,
5231 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5232 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5233 max (height, 1));
5234 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5235 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5236 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5237 top,
5238 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5239 max (height, 1), 0);
5240 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5241 }
5242 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5243
5244 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5245 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5246 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5247 {
5248 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5249 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5250 height, False);
5251 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5252 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5253 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5254 height, False);
5255 }
5256
5257 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5258 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5259 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5260 example. */
5261 {
5262 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5263 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5264 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5265 {
5266 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5267 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5268 left + area_width - rest, top,
5269 rest, height, False);
5270 else
5271 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5272 left, top, rest, height, False);
5273 }
5274 }
5275
5276 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5277 if (mask)
5278 {
5279 XWindowChanges wc;
5280
5281 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5282 wc.y = top;
5283 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5284 wc.height = height;
5285 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5286 mask, &wc);
5287 }
5288
5289 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5290
5291 /* Remember new settings. */
5292 bar->left = sb_left;
5293 bar->top = top;
5294 bar->width = sb_width;
5295 bar->height = height;
5296
5297 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5298 }
5299
5300 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5301 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5302
5303 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5304 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5305 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5306 dragged. */
5307 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5308 {
5309 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5310
5311 if (whole == 0)
5312 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5313 else
5314 {
5315 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5316 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5317 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5318 }
5319 }
5320 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5321
5322 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5323 }
5324
5325
5326 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5327 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5328 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5329 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5330 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5331 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5332 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5333
5334 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5335 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5336 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5337
5338 static void
5339 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5340 {
5341 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5342 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5343 {
5344 Lisp_Object bar;
5345 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5346 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5347 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5348 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5349 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5350 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5351 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5352 }
5353 }
5354
5355
5356 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5357 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5358
5359 static void
5360 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5361 {
5362 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5363 struct frame *f;
5364
5365 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5366 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5367 abort ();
5368
5369 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5370
5371 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5372 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5373 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5374 {
5375 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5376 the lists. */
5377 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5378 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5379 return;
5380 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5381 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5382 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5383 else
5384 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5385 one or the other! */
5386 abort ();
5387 }
5388 else
5389 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5390
5391 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5392 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5393
5394 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5395 bar->prev = Qnil;
5396 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5397 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5398 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5399 }
5400
5401 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5402 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5403
5404 static void
5405 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5406 {
5407 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5408
5409 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5410
5411 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5412 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5413 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5414
5415 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5416 {
5417 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5418
5419 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5420
5421 next = b->next;
5422 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5423 }
5424
5425 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5426 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5427 }
5428
5429
5430 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5431 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5432 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5433
5434 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5435 mark bits. */
5436
5437 static void
5438 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5439 {
5440 Window w = bar->x_window;
5441 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5442 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5443 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5444
5445 BLOCK_INPUT;
5446
5447 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5448
5449 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5450 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5451 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5452 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5453
5454 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5455 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5456
5457 /* x, y, width, height */
5458 0, 0,
5459 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5460 bar->height - 1);
5461
5462 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5463 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5464 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5465 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5466
5467 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5468
5469 }
5470 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5471
5472 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5473 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5474
5475 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5476 mark bits. */
5477
5478
5479 static void
5480 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5481 {
5482 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5483 abort ();
5484
5485 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5486 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5487 emacs_event->modifiers
5488 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5489 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5490 event->xbutton.state)
5491 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5492 ? up_modifier
5493 : down_modifier));
5494 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5495 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5496 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5497 {
5498 int top_range
5499 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5500 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5501
5502 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5503 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5504
5505 if (y < bar->start)
5506 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5507 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5508 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5509 else
5510 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5511
5512 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5513 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5514 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5515 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5516 {
5517 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5518 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5519
5520 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5521 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5522 }
5523 #endif
5524
5525 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5526 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5527 }
5528 }
5529
5530 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5531
5532 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5533
5534 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5535 mark bits. */
5536
5537 static void
5538 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5539 {
5540 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5541
5542 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5543
5544 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5545 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5546
5547 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5548 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5549 {
5550 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5551 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5552
5553 if (new_start != bar->start)
5554 {
5555 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5556
5557 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5558 }
5559 }
5560 }
5561
5562 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5563
5564 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5565 on the scroll bar. */
5566
5567 static void
5568 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window, enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *time)
5569 {
5570 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5571 Window w = bar->x_window;
5572 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5573 int win_x, win_y;
5574 Window dummy_window;
5575 int dummy_coord;
5576 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5577
5578 BLOCK_INPUT;
5579
5580 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5581 report that. */
5582 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5583
5584 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5585 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5586 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5587
5588 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5589 &win_x, &win_y,
5590
5591 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5592 &dummy_mask))
5593 ;
5594 else
5595 {
5596 int top_range
5597 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5598
5599 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5600
5601 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5602 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5603
5604 if (win_y < 0)
5605 win_y = 0;
5606 if (win_y > top_range)
5607 win_y = top_range;
5608
5609 *fp = f;
5610 *bar_window = bar->window;
5611
5612 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5613 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5614 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5615 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5616 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5617 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5618 else
5619 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5620
5621 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5622 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5623
5624 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5625 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5626 }
5627
5628 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5629
5630 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5631 }
5632
5633
5634 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5635 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5636 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5637 redraw them. */
5638
5639 static void
5640 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5641 {
5642 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5643 Lisp_Object bar;
5644
5645 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5646 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5647 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5648 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5649 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5650 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5651 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5652 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5653 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5654 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5655 }
5656
5657 \f
5658 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5659
5660 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5661 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5662 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5663 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5664
5665 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5666 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5667
5668 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5669
5670 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5671 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5672
5673 static int temp_index;
5674 static short temp_buffer[100];
5675
5676 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5677 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5678 temp_index = 0; \
5679 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5680
5681 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5682 on a particular display. */
5683
5684 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5685
5686 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5687 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5688 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5689 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5690
5691 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5692
5693 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5694 do \
5695 { \
5696 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5697 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5698 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5699 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5700 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5701 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5702 } \
5703 while (0)
5704
5705 enum
5706 {
5707 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5708 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5709 X_EVENT_DROP
5710 };
5711
5712 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5713 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5714 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5715
5716 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5717 this event further.
5718 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5719
5720 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5721 static int
5722 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5723 {
5724 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5725 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5726 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5727 was created. */
5728
5729 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5730 event->xclient.window);
5731
5732 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5733 }
5734 #endif
5735
5736 #ifdef USE_GTK
5737 static int current_count;
5738 static int current_finish;
5739 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5740
5741 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5742 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5743 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5744 static GdkFilterReturn
5745 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5746 {
5747 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5748
5749 BLOCK_INPUT;
5750 if (current_count >= 0)
5751 {
5752 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5753
5754 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5755
5756 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5757 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5758 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5759 so we do it here. */
5760 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5761 && dpyinfo
5762 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5763 {
5764 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5765 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5766 }
5767 #endif
5768
5769 if (! dpyinfo)
5770 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5771 else
5772 current_count +=
5773 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5774 current_hold_quit);
5775 }
5776 else
5777 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5778
5779 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5780
5781 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5782 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5783
5784 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5785 }
5786 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5787
5788
5789 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time time,
5790 enum xembed_message message,
5791 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5792
5793 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5794
5795 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5796 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5797 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5798
5799 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5800
5801 static int
5802 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventp, int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5803 {
5804 union {
5805 struct input_event ie;
5806 struct selection_input_event sie;
5807 } inev;
5808 int count = 0;
5809 int do_help = 0;
5810 int nbytes = 0;
5811 struct frame *f = NULL;
5812 struct coding_system coding;
5813 XEvent event = *eventp;
5814 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5815
5816 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5817
5818 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5819 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5820 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5821
5822 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5823 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5824
5825 switch (event.type)
5826 {
5827 case ClientMessage:
5828 {
5829 if (event.xclient.message_type
5830 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5831 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5832 {
5833 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5834 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5835 {
5836 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5837 could be the shell widget window
5838 if the frame has no title bar. */
5839 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5840 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5841 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5842 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5843 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5844 #endif
5845 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5846 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5847 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5848 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5849 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5850 needed.
5851
5852 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5853 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5854 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5855 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5856 Emacs. */
5857
5858 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5859 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5860 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5861 if (f)
5862 {
5863 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5864 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5865 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5866 x_catch_errors (d);
5867 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5868 /* The ICCCM says this is
5869 the only valid choice. */
5870 RevertToParent,
5871 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5872 /* This is needed to detect the error
5873 if there is an error. */
5874 XSync (d, False);
5875 x_uncatch_errors ();
5876 }
5877 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5878 #endif /* 0 */
5879 goto done;
5880 }
5881
5882 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5883 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5884 {
5885 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5886 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5887 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5888 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5889 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5890 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5891 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5892 session manager and one for this. */
5893 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5894 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5895 #endif
5896 {
5897 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5898 event.xclient.window);
5899 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5900 for a single Emacs process. */
5901 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5902 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5903 event.xclient.window,
5904 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5905 else if (f)
5906 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5907 event.xclient.window,
5908 0, 0);
5909 }
5910 goto done;
5911 }
5912
5913 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5914 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5915 {
5916 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5917 event.xclient.window);
5918 if (!f)
5919 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5920
5921 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5922 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5923 goto done;
5924 }
5925
5926 goto done;
5927 }
5928
5929 if (event.xclient.message_type
5930 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5931 {
5932 goto done;
5933 }
5934
5935 if (event.xclient.message_type
5936 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5937 {
5938 int new_x, new_y;
5939 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5940
5941 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5942 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5943
5944 if (f)
5945 {
5946 f->left_pos = new_x;
5947 f->top_pos = new_y;
5948 }
5949 goto done;
5950 }
5951
5952 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5953 if (event.xclient.message_type
5954 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5955 {
5956 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5957 if (f)
5958 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5959 &event, NULL);
5960 goto done;
5961 }
5962 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5963
5964 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5965 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5966 || (event.xclient.message_type
5967 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5968 {
5969 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5970 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5971 currently never do because we are interested in
5972 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5973 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5974 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5975 if (!f)
5976 goto OTHER;
5977 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5978 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5979 goto done;
5980 }
5981
5982 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5983 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5984 we construct an input_event. */
5985 if (event.xclient.message_type
5986 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5987 {
5988 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5989 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5990 goto done;
5991 }
5992 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5993
5994 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
5995 if (event.xclient.message_type
5996 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
5997 {
5998 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
5999 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6000 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6001
6002 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6003 goto done;
6004 }
6005
6006 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6007
6008 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6009 if (!f)
6010 goto OTHER;
6011 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6012 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6013 }
6014 break;
6015
6016 case SelectionNotify:
6017 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6018 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6019 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6020 goto OTHER;
6021 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6022 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6023 break;
6024
6025 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6026 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6027 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6028 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6029 goto OTHER;
6030 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6031 {
6032 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
6033
6034 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6035 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6036 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6037 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6038 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6039 }
6040 break;
6041
6042 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6043 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6044 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6045 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6046 goto OTHER;
6047 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6048 {
6049 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
6050 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
6051
6052 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6053 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6054 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6055 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6056 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6057 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6058 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6059 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6060 }
6061 break;
6062
6063 case PropertyNotify:
6064 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6065 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6066 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6067 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
6068
6069 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6070 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6071 goto OTHER;
6072
6073 case ReparentNotify:
6074 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6075 if (f)
6076 {
6077 int x, y;
6078 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6079 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6080 f->left_pos = x;
6081 f->top_pos = y;
6082
6083 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6084 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6085 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6086 }
6087 goto OTHER;
6088
6089 case Expose:
6090 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6091 if (f)
6092 {
6093 #ifdef USE_GTK
6094 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6095 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6096 event.xexpose.window,
6097 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6098 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6099 FALSE);
6100 #endif
6101 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6102 {
6103 f->async_visible = 1;
6104 f->async_iconified = 0;
6105 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6106 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6107 }
6108 else
6109 expose_frame (f,
6110 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6111 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6112 }
6113 else
6114 {
6115 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6116 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6117 #endif
6118 #if defined USE_LUCID
6119 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6120 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6121 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6122 {
6123 Widget widget
6124 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6125 if (widget)
6126 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6127 }
6128 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6129
6130 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6131 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6132 goto OTHER;
6133 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6134 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6135 event.xexpose.window);
6136
6137 if (bar)
6138 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6139 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6140 else
6141 goto OTHER;
6142 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6143 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6144 }
6145 break;
6146
6147 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6148 source area was obscured or not
6149 available. */
6150 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6151 if (f)
6152 {
6153 expose_frame (f,
6154 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6155 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6156 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6157 }
6158 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6159 else
6160 goto OTHER;
6161 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6162 break;
6163
6164 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6165 source area was completely
6166 available. */
6167 break;
6168
6169 case UnmapNotify:
6170 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6171 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6172 {
6173 tip_window = 0;
6174 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6175 }
6176
6177 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6178 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6179 the frame was deleted. */
6180 {
6181 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6182 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6183 display that won't ever be seen. */
6184 f->async_visible = 0;
6185 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6186 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6187 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6188 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6189 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6190 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6191 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6192 {
6193 f->async_iconified = 1;
6194
6195 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6196 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6197 }
6198 }
6199 goto OTHER;
6200
6201 case MapNotify:
6202 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6203 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6204 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6205 goto OTHER;
6206
6207 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6208 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6209 frame is visible. */
6210 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6211 if (f)
6212 {
6213 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6214 the frame's display structures.
6215 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6216 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6217 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6218 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6219 if (! f->async_iconified)
6220 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6221
6222 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6223 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6224 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6225 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6226
6227 f->async_visible = 1;
6228 f->async_iconified = 0;
6229 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6230
6231 if (f->iconified)
6232 {
6233 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6234 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6235 }
6236 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6237 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6238 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6239 to update the frame titles
6240 in case this is the second frame. */
6241 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6242
6243 #ifdef USE_GTK
6244 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6245 #endif
6246 }
6247 goto OTHER;
6248
6249 case KeyPress:
6250
6251 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6252 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6253
6254 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6255 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6256 if (popup_activated ())
6257 goto OTHER;
6258 #endif
6259
6260 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6261
6262 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6263 mouse highlighting. */
6264 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6265 && (f == 0
6266 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6267 {
6268 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6269 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6270 }
6271
6272 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6273 if (f == 0)
6274 {
6275 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6276 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6277 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6278 event.xkey.window);
6279 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6280 {
6281 widget = XtParent (widget);
6282 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6283 }
6284 }
6285 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6286
6287 if (f != 0)
6288 {
6289 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6290 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6291 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6292 his Emacs hang.
6293
6294 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6295 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6296 status_return even if the input is too long to
6297 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6298 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6299 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6300 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6301 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6302 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6303 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6304 int modifiers;
6305 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6306 Lisp_Object c;
6307
6308 #ifdef USE_GTK
6309 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6310 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6311 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6312 (see above). */
6313 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6314 #endif
6315
6316 event.xkey.state
6317 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6318 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6319 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6320
6321 /* This will have to go some day... */
6322
6323 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6324 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6325 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6326 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6327 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6328 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6329 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6330
6331 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6332 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6333 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6334 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6335 not it is combined with Meta. */
6336 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6337 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6338
6339 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6340 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6341 {
6342 Status status_return;
6343
6344 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6345 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6346 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6347 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6348 &status_return);
6349 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6350 {
6351 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6352 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6353 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6354 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6355 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6356 &status_return);
6357 }
6358 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6359 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6360 break;
6361 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6362 {
6363 keysym = NoSymbol;
6364 modifiers = 0;
6365 }
6366 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6367 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6368 abort ();
6369 }
6370 else
6371 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6372 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6373 &compose_status);
6374 #else
6375 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6376 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6377 &compose_status);
6378 #endif
6379
6380 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6381 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6382 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6383 break;
6384
6385 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6386 orig_keysym = keysym;
6387
6388 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6389 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6390 inev.ie.modifiers
6391 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6392 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6393
6394 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6395 translations to characters. */
6396 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6397 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6398 {
6399 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6400 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6401 goto done_keysym;
6402 }
6403
6404 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6405 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6406 {
6407 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6408 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6409 else
6410 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6411 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6412 goto done_keysym;
6413 }
6414
6415 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6416 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6417 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6418 Vx_keysym_table,
6419 Qnil))))
6420 {
6421 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6422 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6423 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6424 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6425 goto done_keysym;
6426 }
6427
6428 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6429 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6430 || keysym == XK_Delete
6431 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6432 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6433 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6434 #endif
6435 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6436 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6437 #ifdef HPUX
6438 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6439 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6440 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6441 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6442 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6443 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6444 #endif
6445 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6446 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6447 #endif
6448 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6449 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6450 #endif
6451 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6452 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6453 #endif
6454 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6455 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6456 #endif
6457 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6458 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6459 #endif
6460 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6461 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6462 #endif
6463 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6464 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6465 #endif
6466 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6467 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6468 #endif
6469 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6470 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6471 #endif
6472 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6473 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6474 #endif
6475 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6476 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6477 #endif
6478 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6479 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6480 #endif
6481 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6482 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6483 #endif
6484 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6485 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6486 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6487 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6488 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6489 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6490 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6491 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6492 don't have real modifiers but
6493 should be treated similarly to
6494 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6495 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6496 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6497 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6498 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6499 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6500 #endif
6501 ))
6502 {
6503 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6504 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6505 key. */
6506 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6507 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6508 goto done_keysym;
6509 }
6510
6511 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6512 register int i;
6513 register int c;
6514 int nchars, len;
6515
6516 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6517 {
6518 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6519 nchars++;
6520 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6521 }
6522
6523 if (nchars < nbytes)
6524 {
6525 /* Decode the input data. */
6526 int require;
6527
6528 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6529 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6530 we used just above and the locale. */
6531 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6532 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6533 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6534 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6535 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6536 gives us composition information. */
6537 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6538
6539 require = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6540 coding.destination = alloca (require);
6541 coding.dst_bytes = require;
6542 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6543 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6544 nbytes = coding.produced;
6545 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6546 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6547 }
6548
6549 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6550 character events. */
6551 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6552 {
6553 if (nchars == nbytes)
6554 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6555 else
6556 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6557 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6558 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6559 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6560 inev.ie.code = c;
6561 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6562 }
6563
6564 count += nchars;
6565
6566 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6567
6568 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6569 break;
6570 }
6571 }
6572 done_keysym:
6573 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6574 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6575 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6576 client. */
6577 break;
6578 #else
6579 goto OTHER;
6580 #endif
6581
6582 case KeyRelease:
6583 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6584 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6585 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6586 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6587 client. */
6588 break;
6589 #else
6590 goto OTHER;
6591 #endif
6592
6593 case EnterNotify:
6594 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6595 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6596
6597 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6598
6599 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6600 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6601
6602 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6603 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6604 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6605 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6606 #ifdef USE_GTK
6607 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6608 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6609 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6610 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6611 #endif
6612 goto OTHER;
6613
6614 case FocusIn:
6615 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6616 goto OTHER;
6617
6618 case LeaveNotify:
6619 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6620 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6621
6622 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6623 if (f)
6624 {
6625 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6626 {
6627 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6628 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6629 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6630 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6631 }
6632
6633 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6634 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6635 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6636 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6637 if (any_help_event_p)
6638 do_help = -1;
6639 }
6640 #ifdef USE_GTK
6641 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6642 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6643 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6644 #endif
6645 goto OTHER;
6646
6647 case FocusOut:
6648 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6649 goto OTHER;
6650
6651 case MotionNotify:
6652 {
6653 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6654 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6655 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6656
6657 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6658 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6659 f = last_mouse_frame;
6660 else
6661 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6662
6663 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6664 {
6665 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6666 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6667 }
6668
6669 #ifdef USE_GTK
6670 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6671 f = 0;
6672 #endif
6673 if (f)
6674 {
6675
6676 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6677 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6678 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6679 {
6680 Lisp_Object window;
6681
6682 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6683 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6684 0, 0);
6685
6686 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6687 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6688 will be selected only when it is active. */
6689 if (WINDOWP (window)
6690 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6691 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6692 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6693 create event iff we don't leave the
6694 selected frame. */
6695 && (focus_follows_mouse
6696 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6697 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6698 {
6699 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6700 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6701 }
6702
6703 last_window=window;
6704 }
6705 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6706 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6707 }
6708 else
6709 {
6710 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6711 struct scroll_bar *bar
6712 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6713 event.xmotion.window);
6714
6715 if (bar)
6716 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6717 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6718
6719 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6720 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6721 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6722 }
6723
6724 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6725 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6726 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6727 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6728 do_help = 1;
6729 goto OTHER;
6730 }
6731
6732 case ConfigureNotify:
6733 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6734 #ifdef USE_GTK
6735 if (!f
6736 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6737 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6738 {
6739 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6740 event.xconfigure.height);
6741 f = 0;
6742 }
6743 #endif
6744 if (f)
6745 {
6746 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6747 #ifndef USE_GTK
6748 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6749 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6750
6751 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6752 is called by the code that handles resizing
6753 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6754
6755 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6756 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6757 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6758 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6759 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6760 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6761 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6762 {
6763 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6764 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6765 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6766 }
6767
6768 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6769 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6770 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6771 #endif
6772
6773 #ifdef USE_GTK
6774 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6775 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6776 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6777 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6778 #endif
6779 {
6780 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6781 }
6782
6783 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6784 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6785 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6786 #endif
6787
6788 }
6789 goto OTHER;
6790
6791 case ButtonRelease:
6792 case ButtonPress:
6793 {
6794 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6795 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6796 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6797
6798 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6799 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6800 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6801
6802 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6803 && last_mouse_frame
6804 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6805 f = last_mouse_frame;
6806 else
6807 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6808
6809 #ifdef USE_GTK
6810 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6811 f = 0;
6812 #endif
6813 if (f)
6814 {
6815 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6816 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6817 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6818 {
6819 Lisp_Object window;
6820 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6821 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6822
6823 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6824 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6825
6826 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6827 {
6828 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6829 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6830 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6831 event.xbutton.state));
6832 }
6833 }
6834
6835 if (!tool_bar_p)
6836 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6837 if (! popup_activated ())
6838 #endif
6839 {
6840 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6841 {
6842 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6843 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6844 {
6845 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6846 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6847 }
6848 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6849 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6850 }
6851 else
6852 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6853 }
6854 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6855 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6856 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6857 }
6858 else
6859 {
6860 struct scroll_bar *bar
6861 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6862 event.xbutton.window);
6863
6864 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6865 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6866 scroll bars. */
6867 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6868 {
6869 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6870 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6871 }
6872 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6873 if (bar)
6874 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6875 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6876 }
6877
6878 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6879 {
6880 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6881 last_mouse_frame = f;
6882
6883 if (!tool_bar_p)
6884 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6885 }
6886 else
6887 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6888
6889 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6890 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6891 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6892 if (f != 0)
6893 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6894
6895 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6896 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6897 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6898 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6899 Instead, save it away
6900 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6901 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6902 if (! popup_activated ()
6903 #ifdef USE_GTK
6904 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6905 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6906 #endif
6907 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6908 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6909 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6910 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6911 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6912 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6913 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6914 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6915 {
6916 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6917 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6918 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6919 }
6920 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6921 {
6922 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6923 goto OTHER;
6924 }
6925 else
6926 goto OTHER;
6927 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6928 }
6929 break;
6930
6931 case CirculateNotify:
6932 goto OTHER;
6933
6934 case CirculateRequest:
6935 goto OTHER;
6936
6937 case VisibilityNotify:
6938 goto OTHER;
6939
6940 case MappingNotify:
6941 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6942 local cache. */
6943 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6944 {
6945 case MappingModifier:
6946 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6947 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6948 case MappingKeyboard:
6949 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6950 }
6951 goto OTHER;
6952
6953 case DestroyNotify:
6954 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6955 break;
6956
6957 default:
6958 OTHER:
6959 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6960 BLOCK_INPUT;
6961 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6962 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6963 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6964 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6965 break;
6966 }
6967
6968 done:
6969 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6970 {
6971 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6972 count++;
6973 }
6974
6975 if (do_help
6976 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6977 {
6978 Lisp_Object frame;
6979
6980 if (f)
6981 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6982 else
6983 frame = Qnil;
6984
6985 if (do_help > 0)
6986 {
6987 any_help_event_p = 1;
6988 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6989 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6990 }
6991 else
6992 {
6993 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6994 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6995 }
6996 count++;
6997 }
6998
6999 *eventp = event;
7000 return count;
7001 }
7002
7003
7004 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7005 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7006 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7007
7008 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7009 int
7010 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7011 {
7012 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7013 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7014
7015 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7016
7017 if (dpyinfo)
7018 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7019
7020 return finish;
7021 }
7022
7023
7024 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7025 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7026 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7027
7028 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7029 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7030 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7031 C chars).
7032
7033 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7034
7035 static int
7036 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7037 {
7038 int count = 0;
7039 XEvent event;
7040 int event_found = 0;
7041
7042 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7043 {
7044 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7045 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7046 pending_signals = 1;
7047 #endif
7048 return -1;
7049 }
7050
7051 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7052 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7053 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7054 #endif
7055 BLOCK_INPUT;
7056
7057 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7058 input_signal_count++;
7059
7060 ++handling_signal;
7061
7062 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7063 /* Only check session manager input for the primary display. */
7064 if (terminal->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
7065 {
7066 struct input_event inev;
7067 BLOCK_INPUT;
7068 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7069 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7070 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7071 {
7072 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7073 count++;
7074 }
7075 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7076 }
7077 #endif
7078
7079 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7080 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7081 {
7082 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7083 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7084 }
7085
7086 #ifndef USE_GTK
7087 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7088 {
7089 int finish;
7090
7091 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7092
7093 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7094 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7095 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7096 continue;
7097 #endif
7098 event_found = 1;
7099
7100 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7101 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7102
7103 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7104 goto out;
7105 }
7106
7107 #else /* USE_GTK */
7108
7109 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7110 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7111 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7112 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7113
7114 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7115 from all displays. */
7116
7117 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7118 {
7119 current_count = count;
7120 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7121
7122 gtk_main_iteration ();
7123
7124 count = current_count;
7125 current_count = -1;
7126 current_hold_quit = 0;
7127
7128 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7129 break;
7130 }
7131 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7132
7133 out:;
7134
7135 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7136 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7137 if (! event_found)
7138 {
7139 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7140 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7141 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7142 x_noop_count++;
7143 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7144 {
7145 x_noop_count=0;
7146
7147 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7148 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7149
7150 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7151
7152 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7153 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7154 }
7155 }
7156
7157 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7158 raise it now. */
7159 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7160 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7161 {
7162 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7163 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7164 }
7165
7166 --handling_signal;
7167 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7168
7169 return count;
7170 }
7171
7172
7173
7174 \f
7175 /***********************************************************************
7176 Text Cursor
7177 ***********************************************************************/
7178
7179 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7180 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7181
7182 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7183 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7184 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7185
7186 static void
7187 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7188 {
7189 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7190 XRectangle clip_rect;
7191 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7192
7193 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7194
7195 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7196 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7197 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7198 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7199 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7200
7201 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7202 }
7203
7204
7205 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7206
7207 static void
7208 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7209 {
7210 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7211 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7212 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7213 int x, y, wd, h;
7214 XGCValues xgcv;
7215 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7216 GC gc;
7217
7218 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7219 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7220 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7221 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7222 return;
7223
7224 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7225 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7226 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7227
7228 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7229 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7230 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7231 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7232 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7233 else
7234 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7235 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7236 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7237
7238 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7239 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7240 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7241 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7242 }
7243
7244
7245 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7246
7247 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7248 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7249 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7250 --gerd. */
7251
7252 static void
7253 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7254 {
7255 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7256 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7257
7258 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7259 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7260 and mini-buffer. */
7261 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7262 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7263 return;
7264
7265 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7266 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7267 the bar might not be in the window. */
7268 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7269 {
7270 struct glyph_row *row;
7271 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7272 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7273 }
7274 else
7275 {
7276 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7277 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7278 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7279 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7280 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7281 XGCValues xgcv;
7282
7283 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7284 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7285 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7286 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7287 that the glyph is legible. */
7288 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7289 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7290 else
7291 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7292 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7293
7294 if (gc)
7295 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7296 else
7297 {
7298 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7299 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7300 }
7301
7302 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7303
7304 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7305 {
7306 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7307
7308 if (width < 0)
7309 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7310 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7311
7312 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7313
7314 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7315 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7316 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7317 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7318
7319 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7320 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7321 width, row->height);
7322 }
7323 else
7324 {
7325 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7326
7327 if (width < 0)
7328 width = row->height;
7329
7330 width = min (row->height, width);
7331
7332 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7333 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7334
7335 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7336 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7337 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7338 row->height - width),
7339 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7340 }
7341
7342 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7343 }
7344 }
7345
7346
7347 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7348
7349 static void
7350 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7351 {
7352 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7353 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7354 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7355 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7356 }
7357
7358
7359 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7360
7361 static void
7362 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7363 {
7364 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7365 x, y, width, height, False);
7366 #ifdef USE_GTK
7367 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7368 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7369 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7370 #endif
7371 }
7372
7373
7374 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7375
7376 static void
7377 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7378 {
7379 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7380
7381 if (on_p)
7382 {
7383 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7384 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7385
7386 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7387 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7388 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7389 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7390 {
7391 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7392 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7393 }
7394 else
7395 {
7396 switch (cursor_type)
7397 {
7398 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7399 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7400 break;
7401
7402 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7403 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7404 break;
7405
7406 case BAR_CURSOR:
7407 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7408 break;
7409
7410 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7411 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7412 break;
7413
7414 case NO_CURSOR:
7415 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7416 break;
7417
7418 default:
7419 abort ();
7420 }
7421 }
7422
7423 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7424 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7425 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7426 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7427 #endif
7428 }
7429
7430 #ifndef XFlush
7431 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7432 #endif
7433 }
7434
7435 \f
7436 /* Icons. */
7437
7438 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7439
7440 int
7441 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7442 {
7443 int bitmap_id;
7444
7445 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7446 return 1;
7447
7448 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7449 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7450 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7451 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7452
7453 if (STRINGP (file))
7454 {
7455 #ifdef USE_GTK
7456 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7457 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7458 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7459 return 0;
7460 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7461 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7462 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7463 }
7464 else
7465 {
7466 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7467 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7468 {
7469 int rc = -1;
7470
7471 #ifdef USE_GTK
7472
7473 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7474 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7475 return 0;
7476
7477 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7478
7479 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7480 if (rc != -1)
7481 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7482
7483 #endif
7484
7485 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7486 if (rc == -1)
7487 {
7488 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7489 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7490 if (rc == -1)
7491 return 1;
7492
7493 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7494 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7495 }
7496 }
7497
7498 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7499 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7500 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7501 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7502 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7503
7504 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7505 }
7506
7507 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7508 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7509
7510 return 0;
7511 }
7512
7513
7514 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7515 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7516
7517 int
7518 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7519 {
7520 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7521 return 1;
7522
7523 {
7524 XTextProperty text;
7525 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7526 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7527 text.format = 8;
7528 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7529 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7530 }
7531
7532 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7533 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7534 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7535 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7536
7537 return 0;
7538 }
7539 \f
7540 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7541
7542 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7543 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7544
7545 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7546 be called from a signal handler.
7547 */
7548
7549 struct x_error_message_stack {
7550 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7551 Display *dpy;
7552 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7553 };
7554 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7555
7556 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7557 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7558 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7559
7560 static void
7561 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7562 {
7563 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7564 x_error_message->string,
7565 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7566 }
7567
7568 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7569 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7570 operating on.
7571
7572 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7573 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7574 stored in *x_error_message.
7575
7576 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7577 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7578
7579 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7580
7581 void x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format);
7582
7583 void
7584 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7585 {
7586 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7587
7588 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7589 XSync (dpy, False);
7590
7591 data->dpy = dpy;
7592 data->string[0] = 0;
7593 data->prev = x_error_message;
7594 x_error_message = data;
7595 }
7596
7597 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7598 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7599
7600 void
7601 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7602 {
7603 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7604
7605 BLOCK_INPUT;
7606
7607 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7608 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7609 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7610 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7611
7612 tmp = x_error_message;
7613 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7614 xfree (tmp);
7615 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7616 }
7617
7618 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7619 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7620 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7621
7622 void
7623 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7624 {
7625 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7626 XSync (dpy, False);
7627
7628 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7629 {
7630 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7631 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7632 x_uncatch_errors ();
7633 error (format, string);
7634 }
7635 }
7636
7637 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7638 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7639
7640 int
7641 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7642 {
7643 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7644 XSync (dpy, False);
7645
7646 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7647 }
7648
7649 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7650
7651 void
7652 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7653 {
7654 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7655 }
7656
7657 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7658 * idea. --lorentey */
7659 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7660
7661 void
7662 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7663 {
7664 while (x_error_message)
7665 x_uncatch_errors ();
7666 }
7667 #endif
7668
7669 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7670
7671 int
7672 x_catching_errors (void)
7673 {
7674 return x_error_message != 0;
7675 }
7676
7677 #if 0
7678 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7679 x_trace_wire (void)
7680 {
7681 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7682 }
7683 #endif /* ! 0 */
7684
7685 \f
7686 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7687 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7688 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7689 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7690 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7691
7692 static SIGTYPE
7693 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7694 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7695 {
7696 #ifdef USG
7697 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7698 must reestablish each time */
7699 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7700 #endif /* USG */
7701 }
7702
7703 \f
7704 /************************************************************************
7705 Handling X errors
7706 ************************************************************************/
7707
7708 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7709
7710 static char *error_msg;
7711
7712 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7713 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7714 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7715
7716 static void
7717 x_fatal_error_signal (void)
7718 {
7719 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7720 exit (70);
7721 }
7722
7723 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7724 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7725
7726 static SIGTYPE
7727 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7728 {
7729 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7730 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7731 int index = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7732
7733 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7734 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7735 handling_signal = 0;
7736
7737 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7738 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7739 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7740 the original message here. */
7741 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7742
7743 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7744 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7745
7746 if (dpyinfo)
7747 {
7748 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7749 frame on it. */
7750 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7751 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7752 }
7753
7754 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7755 that are on the dead display. */
7756 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7757 {
7758 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7759 minibuf_frame
7760 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7761 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7762 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7763 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7764 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7765 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7766 }
7767
7768 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7769 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7770 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7771 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7772 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7773 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7774 {
7775 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7776 trying to find a replacement. */
7777 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7778 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7779 }
7780
7781 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7782 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7783 if (dpyinfo)
7784 {
7785 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7786 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7787 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7788 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7789
7790 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7791 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7792 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7793
7794 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1',
7795 opened in the first call to make-frame-on-display.
7796
7797 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7798 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7799 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to circumvent it here. */
7800 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7801 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7802 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7803 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7804
7805 #ifdef USE_GTK
7806 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7807 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7808 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7809 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7810 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7811 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7812 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7813 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7814 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7815 error_msg);
7816 abort ();
7817 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7818
7819 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7820 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7821
7822 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7823 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7824 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7825 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7826 abort ();
7827
7828 {
7829 Lisp_Object tmp;
7830 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7831 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7832 }
7833 }
7834
7835 x_uncatch_errors ();
7836
7837 if (terminal_list == 0)
7838 {
7839 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7840 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7841 /* NOTREACHED */
7842 }
7843
7844 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7845 #ifdef SIGIO
7846 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7847 #endif
7848 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7849 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7850
7851 unbind_to (index, Qnil);
7852 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7853 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7854 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7855 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7856 error ("%s", error_msg);
7857 }
7858
7859 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7860 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7861 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7862
7863 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7864 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7865
7866 static int
7867 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7868 {
7869 if (x_error_message)
7870 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7871 else
7872 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7873 return 0;
7874 }
7875
7876 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7877 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7878 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7879
7880 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7881
7882 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7883 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7884
7885 static void NO_INLINE
7886 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7887 {
7888 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7889
7890 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7891 or colors that are not defined. */
7892
7893 if (error->error_code == BadName)
7894 return;
7895
7896 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7897 original error handler. */
7898
7899 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7900 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7901 buf, error->request_code);
7902 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7903 }
7904
7905
7906 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7907 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7908 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7909
7910 static int
7911 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7912 {
7913 char buf[256];
7914
7915 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7916 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7917 return 0;
7918 }
7919 \f
7920 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7921
7922 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7923 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7924 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7925 FONT-OBJECT. */
7926
7927 Lisp_Object
7928 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7929 {
7930 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7931
7932 if (fontset < 0)
7933 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7934 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7935 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7936 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7937 do. */
7938 return font_object;
7939
7940 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7941 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7942 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7943 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7944 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7945
7946 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7947
7948 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7949 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7950 {
7951 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7952 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7953 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7954 }
7955 else
7956 {
7957 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7958 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7959 }
7960
7961 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7962 {
7963 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7964 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7965 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7966 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7967 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7968 }
7969
7970 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7971 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7972 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7973 {
7974 BLOCK_INPUT;
7975 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7976 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7977 }
7978 #endif
7979
7980 return font_object;
7981 }
7982
7983 \f
7984 /***********************************************************************
7985 X Input Methods
7986 ***********************************************************************/
7987
7988 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7989
7990 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7991
7992 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7993 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7994 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7995
7996 static void
7997 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7998 {
7999 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8000 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8001
8002 BLOCK_INPUT;
8003
8004 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8005 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8006 {
8007 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8008 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8009 {
8010 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8011 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8012 }
8013 }
8014
8015 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8016 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8017 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8018 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8019 }
8020
8021 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8022
8023 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8024 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8025 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8026 #endif
8027
8028 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8029 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8030
8031 static void
8032 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8033 {
8034 XIM xim;
8035
8036 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8037 if (use_xim)
8038 {
8039 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8040 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8041 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8042 emacs_class);
8043 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8044
8045 if (xim)
8046 {
8047 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8048 XIMCallback destroy;
8049 #endif
8050
8051 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8052 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8053
8054 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8055 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8056 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8057 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8058 #endif
8059 }
8060 }
8061
8062 else
8063 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8064 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8065 }
8066
8067
8068 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8069
8070 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8071 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8072 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8073 when the callback was registered. */
8074
8075 static void
8076 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8077 {
8078 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8079 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8080
8081 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8082 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8083 return;
8084
8085 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8086
8087 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8088 as they have no XIC. */
8089 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8090 {
8091 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8092
8093 BLOCK_INPUT;
8094 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8095 {
8096 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8097
8098 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8099 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8100 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8101 {
8102 create_frame_xic (f);
8103 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8104 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8105 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8106 {
8107 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8108 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8109 }
8110 }
8111 }
8112
8113 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8114 }
8115 }
8116
8117 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8118
8119
8120 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8121 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8122 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8123 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8124
8125 static void
8126 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8127 {
8128 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8129 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8130 if (use_xim)
8131 {
8132 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8133 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8134 int len;
8135
8136 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8137 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8138 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8139 len = strlen (resource_name);
8140 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8141 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8142 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8143 resource_name, emacs_class,
8144 xim_instantiate_callback,
8145 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8146 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8147 least, hence the configure test. */
8148 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8149 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8150 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8151 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8152 }
8153 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8154 }
8155
8156
8157 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8158
8159 static void
8160 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8161 {
8162 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8163 if (use_xim)
8164 {
8165 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8166 if (dpyinfo->display)
8167 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8168 NULL, emacs_class,
8169 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8170 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8171 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8172 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8173 if (dpyinfo->display)
8174 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8175 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8176 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8177 }
8178 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8179 }
8180
8181 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8182
8183
8184 \f
8185 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8186 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8187
8188 void
8189 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8190 {
8191 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8192
8193 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8194 is already for the top-left corner. */
8195 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8196 return;
8197
8198 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8199 position that fits on the screen. */
8200 if (flags & XNegative)
8201 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8202 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8203
8204 {
8205 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8206
8207 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8208 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8209 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8210
8211 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8212 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8213 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8214 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8215 is right, though.
8216
8217 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8218 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8219
8220 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8221 #endif
8222
8223 if (flags & YNegative)
8224 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8225 - height + f->top_pos;
8226 }
8227
8228 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8229 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8230 so the flags should correspond. */
8231 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8232 }
8233
8234 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8235 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8236 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8237 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8238 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8239
8240 void
8241 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8242 {
8243 int modified_top, modified_left;
8244
8245 if (change_gravity > 0)
8246 {
8247 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8248 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8249
8250 f->top_pos = yoff;
8251 f->left_pos = xoff;
8252 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8253 if (xoff < 0)
8254 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8255 if (yoff < 0)
8256 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8257 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8258 }
8259 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8260
8261 BLOCK_INPUT;
8262 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8263
8264 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8265 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8266
8267 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8268 {
8269 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8270 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8271 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8272 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8273 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8274 }
8275
8276 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8277 modified_left, modified_top);
8278
8279 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8280 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8281 ? 1 : 0);
8282
8283 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8284 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8285 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8286 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8287 of the frame.
8288
8289 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8290 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8291 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8292
8293 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8294 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8295 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8296 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8297 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8298 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8299
8300 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8301 }
8302
8303 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8304 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8305 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8306 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8307 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8308
8309 static int
8310 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8311 {
8312 Atom actual_type;
8313 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8314 int i, rc, actual_format;
8315 Window wmcheck_window;
8316 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8317 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8318 long max_len = 65536;
8319 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8320 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8321 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8322
8323 BLOCK_INPUT;
8324
8325 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8326 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8327 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8328 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8329 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8330 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8331
8332 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8333 {
8334 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8335 x_uncatch_errors ();
8336 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8337 return 0;
8338 }
8339
8340 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8341 XFree (tmp_data);
8342
8343 /* Check if window exists. */
8344 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8345 x_sync (f);
8346 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8347 {
8348 x_uncatch_errors ();
8349 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8350 return 0;
8351 }
8352
8353 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8354 {
8355 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8356 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8357 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8358 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8359 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8360 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8361
8362 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8363 tmp_data = NULL;
8364 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8365 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8366 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8367 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8368 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8369
8370 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8371 {
8372 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8373 x_uncatch_errors ();
8374 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8375 return 0;
8376 }
8377
8378 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8379 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8380 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8381 }
8382
8383 rc = 0;
8384
8385 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8386 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8387
8388 x_uncatch_errors ();
8389 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8390
8391 return rc;
8392 }
8393
8394 static void
8395 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8396 {
8397 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8398
8399 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8400 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8401 make_number (32),
8402 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8403 Fcons
8404 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8405 Fcons
8406 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8407 value != 0
8408 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8409 : Qnil)));
8410 }
8411
8412 void
8413 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8414 {
8415 Lisp_Object frame;
8416 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8417
8418 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8419
8420 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8421 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8422 }
8423
8424 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8425 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8426 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not. */
8427
8428 static void
8429 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8430 Window window,
8431 int *size_state,
8432 int *sticky)
8433 {
8434 Atom actual_type;
8435 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8436 int i, rc, actual_format;
8437 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8438 long max_len = 65536;
8439 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8440 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8441 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8442
8443 *sticky = 0;
8444 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8445
8446 BLOCK_INPUT;
8447 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8448 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8449 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8450 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8451 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8452
8453 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8454 {
8455 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8456 x_uncatch_errors ();
8457 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8458 return;
8459 }
8460
8461 x_uncatch_errors ();
8462
8463 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8464 {
8465 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8466 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8467 {
8468 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8469 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8470 else
8471 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8472 }
8473 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8474 {
8475 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8476 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8477 else
8478 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8479 }
8480 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8481 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8482 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8483 *sticky = 1;
8484 }
8485
8486 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8487 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8488 }
8489
8490 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8491
8492 static int
8493 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8494 {
8495 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8496 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8497 int cur, dummy;
8498
8499 get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8500
8501 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8502 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8503 if (!have_net_atom)
8504 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8505
8506 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8507 {
8508 Lisp_Object frame;
8509
8510 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8511
8512 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8513 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8514 are sent at once. */
8515 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8516 {
8517 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8518 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8519 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8520 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8521 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8522 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8523 break;
8524 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8525 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8526 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8527 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8528 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8529 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8530 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8531 break;
8532 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8533 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8534 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8535 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8536 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8537 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8538 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8539 break;
8540 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8541 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8542 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8543 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8544 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8545 break;
8546 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8547 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8548 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8549 else
8550 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8551 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8552 }
8553
8554 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8555
8556 }
8557
8558 return have_net_atom;
8559 }
8560
8561 static void
8562 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8563 {
8564 if (f->async_visible)
8565 {
8566 BLOCK_INPUT;
8567 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8568 x_sync (f);
8569 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8570 }
8571 }
8572
8573
8574 static void
8575 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8576 {
8577 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8578 Lisp_Object lval;
8579 int sticky = 0;
8580
8581 get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8582 lval = Qnil;
8583 switch (value)
8584 {
8585 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8586 lval = Qfullwidth;
8587 break;
8588 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8589 lval = Qfullheight;
8590 break;
8591 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8592 lval = Qfullboth;
8593 break;
8594 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8595 lval = Qmaximized;
8596 break;
8597 }
8598
8599 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8600 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8601 }
8602
8603 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8604 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8605 static void
8606 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8607 {
8608 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8609 return;
8610
8611 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8612 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8613
8614 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8615 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8616 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8617
8618 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8619 {
8620 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8621 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8622
8623 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8624 {
8625 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8626 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8627 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8628 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8629 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8630 break;
8631 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8632 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8633 break;
8634 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8635 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8636 }
8637
8638 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8639 width, height);
8640 }
8641 }
8642
8643 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8644 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8645 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8646 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8647 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8648 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8649 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8650
8651 static void
8652 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8653 {
8654 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8655
8656 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8657 window manager window around the frame. */
8658
8659 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8660
8661 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8662 {
8663 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8664
8665 int adjusted_left;
8666 int adjusted_top;
8667
8668 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8669 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8670 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8671
8672 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8673
8674 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8675 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8676
8677 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8678 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8679
8680 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8681 }
8682 else
8683 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8684 frame's position. */
8685
8686 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8687 }
8688
8689
8690 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8691 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8692 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8693 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8694 of an exact comparison. */
8695
8696 static void
8697 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8698 {
8699 int count = 0;
8700
8701 while (count++ < 50)
8702 {
8703 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8704
8705 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8706 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8707 loop. */
8708
8709 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8710 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8711
8712 if (fuzzy)
8713 {
8714 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8715 pixels. */
8716
8717 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8718 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8719 return;
8720 }
8721 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8722 return;
8723 }
8724
8725 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8726 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8727
8728 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8729 }
8730
8731
8732 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8733 void
8734 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8735 {
8736 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8737
8738 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8739 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8740 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8741
8742 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8743 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8744
8745 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8746 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8747 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8748 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8749 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8750
8751 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8752 {
8753 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8754 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8755 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8756 BLOCK_INPUT;
8757 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8758
8759 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8760 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8761
8762 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8763 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8764
8765 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8766 break; /* Timeout */
8767 }
8768 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8769 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8770 }
8771
8772
8773 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8774 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8775 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8776 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8777
8778 static void
8779 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8780 {
8781 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8782
8783 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8784 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8785 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8786 ? 0
8787 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8788
8789 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8790
8791 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8792 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8793 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8794 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8795
8796 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8797 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8798 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8799 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8800
8801
8802 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8803 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8804 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8805 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8806 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8807
8808 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8809 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8810 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8811 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8812
8813 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8814 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8815 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8816 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8817 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8818
8819 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8820 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8821
8822 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8823 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8824 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8825 if (f->async_visible)
8826 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8827 else
8828 {
8829 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8830 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8831 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8832 x_sync (f);
8833 }
8834 }
8835
8836
8837 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8838 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8839 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8840 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8841
8842 void
8843 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8844 {
8845 BLOCK_INPUT;
8846
8847 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8848 {
8849 int r, c;
8850
8851 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8852 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8853 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8854 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8855 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8856 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8857 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8858 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8859 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8860 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8861 is however. */
8862 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8863 #endif
8864 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8865 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8866 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8867 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8868 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8869 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8870 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8871 }
8872
8873 #ifdef USE_GTK
8874 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8875 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8876 else
8877 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8878 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8879
8880 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8881
8882 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8883
8884 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8885 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8886
8887 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8888 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8889 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8890 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8891 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8892
8893 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8894 }
8895 \f
8896 /* Mouse warping. */
8897
8898 void
8899 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8900 {
8901 int pix_x, pix_y;
8902
8903 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8904 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8905
8906 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8907 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8908
8909 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8910 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8911
8912 BLOCK_INPUT;
8913
8914 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8915 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8916 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8917 }
8918
8919 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8920
8921 void
8922 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8923 {
8924 BLOCK_INPUT;
8925
8926 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8927 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8928 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8929 }
8930 \f
8931 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8932
8933 void
8934 x_focus_on_frame (struct frame *f)
8935 {
8936 #if 0
8937 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8938 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8939 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8940 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8941 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8942 #endif /* ! 0 */
8943 }
8944
8945 void
8946 x_unfocus_frame (struct frame *f)
8947 {
8948 #if 0
8949 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8950 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8951 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8952 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8953 #endif /* ! 0 */
8954 }
8955
8956 /* Raise frame F. */
8957
8958 void
8959 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8960 {
8961 BLOCK_INPUT;
8962 if (f->async_visible)
8963 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8964
8965 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8966 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8967 }
8968
8969 /* Lower frame F. */
8970
8971 void
8972 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8973 {
8974 if (f->async_visible)
8975 {
8976 BLOCK_INPUT;
8977 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8978 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8979 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8980 }
8981 }
8982
8983 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8984
8985 void
8986 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8987 {
8988 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8989 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8990
8991 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8992 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8993 {
8994 Lisp_Object frame;
8995 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8996 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8997 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8998 make_number (32),
8999 Fcons (make_number (1),
9000 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
9001 Qnil)));
9002 }
9003 }
9004
9005 static void
9006 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
9007 {
9008 if (raise_flag)
9009 x_raise_frame (f);
9010 else
9011 x_lower_frame (f);
9012 }
9013 \f
9014 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9015
9016 static void
9017 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
9018 {
9019 unsigned long data[2];
9020 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9021
9022 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9023 data[1] = flags;
9024
9025 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9026 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9027 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9028 }
9029
9030 static void
9031 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time time, enum xembed_message message, long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9032 {
9033 XEvent event;
9034
9035 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9036 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9037 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9038 event.xclient.format = 32;
9039 event.xclient.data.l[0] = time;
9040 event.xclient.data.l[1] = message;
9041 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9042 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9043 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9044
9045 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9046 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9047 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9048 }
9049 \f
9050 /* Change of visibility. */
9051
9052 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9053 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9054 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9055 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9056 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9057 finishes with it. */
9058
9059 void
9060 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9061 {
9062 Lisp_Object type;
9063 int original_top, original_left;
9064 int retry_count = 2;
9065
9066 retry:
9067
9068 BLOCK_INPUT;
9069
9070 type = x_icon_type (f);
9071 if (!NILP (type))
9072 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9073
9074 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9075 {
9076 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9077 call x_set_offset a second time
9078 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9079 before the window gets really visible. */
9080 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9081 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9082 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9083 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9084
9085 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9086
9087 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9088 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9089 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9090 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9091 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9092 else
9093 {
9094 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9095 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9096 }
9097 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9098 #ifdef USE_GTK
9099 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9100 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9101 #else
9102 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9103 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9104 else
9105 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9106 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9107 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9108 }
9109
9110 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9111
9112 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9113 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9114 so that incoming events are handled. */
9115 {
9116 Lisp_Object frame;
9117 int count;
9118 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9119 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9120 will set it when they are handled. */
9121 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9122
9123 original_left = f->left_pos;
9124 original_top = f->top_pos;
9125
9126 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9127 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9128
9129 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9130
9131 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9132 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9133 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9134 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9135
9136 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9137 because the window manager may choose the position
9138 and we don't want to override it. */
9139
9140 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9141 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9142 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9143 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9144 && previously_visible)
9145 {
9146 Drawable rootw;
9147 int x, y;
9148 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9149
9150 BLOCK_INPUT;
9151
9152 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9153 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9154 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9155 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9156 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9157 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9158 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9159 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9160 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9161
9162 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9163 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9164 original_left, original_top);
9165
9166 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9167 }
9168
9169 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9170
9171 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9172 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9173 MapNotify at all.. */
9174 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9175 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9176 {
9177 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9178 x_sync (f);
9179
9180 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9181 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9182 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9183 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9184 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9185 probably a bug. */
9186 if (input_polling_used ())
9187 {
9188 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9189 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9190 handler reset it. */
9191 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9192 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9193 poll_for_input_1 ();
9194 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9195 }
9196
9197 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9198 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9199 }
9200
9201 /* 2000-09-28: In
9202
9203 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9204 (iconify-frame f)
9205 (raise-frame f))
9206
9207 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9208 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9209 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9210 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9211
9212 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9213 goto retry;
9214 }
9215 }
9216
9217 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9218
9219 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9220
9221 void
9222 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9223 {
9224 Window window;
9225
9226 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9227 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9228
9229 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9230 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9231 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9232
9233 BLOCK_INPUT;
9234
9235 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9236 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9237 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9238 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9239 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9240 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9241
9242 #ifdef USE_GTK
9243 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9244 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9245 else
9246 #else
9247 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9248 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9249 else
9250 #endif
9251 {
9252
9253 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9254 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9255 {
9256 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9257 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9258 }
9259 }
9260
9261 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9262 just by the event that we get from the server.
9263 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9264 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9265 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9266 f->visible = 0;
9267 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9268 f->async_visible = 0;
9269 f->async_iconified = 0;
9270
9271 x_sync (f);
9272
9273 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9274 }
9275
9276 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9277
9278 void
9279 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9280 {
9281 int result;
9282 Lisp_Object type;
9283
9284 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9285 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9286 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9287
9288 if (f->async_iconified)
9289 return;
9290
9291 BLOCK_INPUT;
9292
9293 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9294
9295 type = x_icon_type (f);
9296 if (!NILP (type))
9297 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9298
9299 #ifdef USE_GTK
9300 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9301 {
9302 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9303 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9304
9305 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9306 f->iconified = 1;
9307 f->visible = 1;
9308 f->async_iconified = 1;
9309 f->async_visible = 0;
9310 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9311 return;
9312 }
9313 #endif
9314
9315 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9316
9317 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9318 {
9319 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9320 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9321 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9322 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9323 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9324 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9325 so we have to record it here. */
9326 f->iconified = 1;
9327 f->visible = 1;
9328 f->async_iconified = 1;
9329 f->async_visible = 0;
9330 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9331 return;
9332 }
9333
9334 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9335 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9336 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9337 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9338
9339 if (!result)
9340 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9341
9342 f->async_iconified = 1;
9343 f->async_visible = 0;
9344
9345
9346 BLOCK_INPUT;
9347 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9348 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9349 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9350
9351 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9352 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9353 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9354 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9355 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9356 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9357
9358 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9359 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9360
9361 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9362 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9363 {
9364 XEvent message;
9365
9366 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9367 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9368 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9369 message.xclient.format = 32;
9370 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9371
9372 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9373 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9374 False,
9375 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9376 &message))
9377 {
9378 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9379 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9380 }
9381 }
9382
9383 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9384 IconicState. */
9385 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9386
9387 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9388 {
9389 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9390 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9391 }
9392
9393 f->async_iconified = 1;
9394 f->async_visible = 0;
9395
9396 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9397 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9398 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9399 }
9400
9401 \f
9402 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9403
9404 void
9405 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9406 {
9407 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9408 Lisp_Object bar;
9409 struct scroll_bar *b;
9410 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9411
9412 BLOCK_INPUT;
9413
9414 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9415 commands to the X server. */
9416 if (dpyinfo->display)
9417 {
9418 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9419 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9420 face. */
9421 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9422 free_frame_faces (f);
9423
9424 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9425 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9426
9427 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9428 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9429 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9430 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9431 toolkit scroll bars. */
9432 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9433 {
9434 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9435 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9436 }
9437 #endif
9438
9439 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9440 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9441 free_frame_xic (f);
9442 #endif
9443
9444 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9445 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9446 {
9447 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9448 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9449 }
9450 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9451 we are using a toolkit. */
9452 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9453 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9454
9455 free_frame_menubar (f);
9456 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9457
9458 #ifdef USE_GTK
9459 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9460 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9461
9462 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9463 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9464 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9465
9466 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9467 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9468 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9469 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9470 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9471 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9472
9473 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9474 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9475 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9476 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9477 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9478 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9479 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9480 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9481 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9482 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9483 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9484 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9485 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9486 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9487 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9488
9489 x_free_gcs (f);
9490 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9491 }
9492
9493 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9494 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9495 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9496
9497 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9498 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9499 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9500 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9501 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9502 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9503
9504 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9505 {
9506 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9507 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9508 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9509 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9510 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9511 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9512 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9513 }
9514
9515 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9516 }
9517
9518
9519 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9520
9521 void
9522 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9523 {
9524 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9525
9526 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9527 commands to the X server. */
9528 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9529 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9530
9531 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9532 }
9533
9534 \f
9535 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9536
9537 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9538 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9539 that the window now has.
9540 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9541 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9542 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9543
9544 #ifndef USE_GTK
9545 void
9546 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9547 {
9548 XSizeHints size_hints;
9549 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9550
9551 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9552 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9553
9554 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9555 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9556
9557 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9558 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9559
9560 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9561 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9562 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9563 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9564 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9565 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9566
9567 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9568 {
9569 int base_width, base_height;
9570 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9571
9572 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9573 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9574
9575 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9576
9577 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9578 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9579 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9580 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9581 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9582
9583 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9584 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9585 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9586
9587 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9588 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9589 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9590 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9591 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9592 }
9593
9594 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9595 if (flags)
9596 {
9597 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9598 goto no_read;
9599 }
9600
9601 {
9602 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9603 long supplied_return;
9604 int value;
9605
9606 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9607 &supplied_return);
9608
9609 if (flags)
9610 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9611 else
9612 {
9613 if (value == 0)
9614 hints.flags = 0;
9615 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9616 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9617 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9618 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9619 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9620 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9621 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9622 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9623 }
9624 }
9625
9626 no_read:
9627
9628 #ifdef PWinGravity
9629 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9630 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9631
9632 if (user_position)
9633 {
9634 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9635 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9636 }
9637 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9638
9639 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9640 }
9641 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9642
9643 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9644
9645 void
9646 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9647 {
9648 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9649 Arg al[1];
9650
9651 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9652 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9653 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9654 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9655
9656 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9657 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9658
9659 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9660 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9661 }
9662
9663 void
9664 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, int pixmap_id)
9665 {
9666 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9667
9668 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9669 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9670 #endif
9671
9672 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9673 {
9674 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9675 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9676 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9677 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9678 }
9679 else
9680 {
9681 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9682 pixmap. */
9683 return;
9684 }
9685
9686
9687 #ifdef USE_GTK
9688 {
9689 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9690 return;
9691 }
9692
9693 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9694
9695 {
9696 Arg al[1];
9697 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9698 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9699 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9700 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9701 }
9702
9703 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9704
9705 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9706 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9707
9708 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9709 }
9710
9711 void
9712 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9713 {
9714 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9715
9716 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9717 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9718 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9719
9720 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9721 }
9722
9723 \f
9724 /***********************************************************************
9725 Fonts
9726 ***********************************************************************/
9727
9728 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9729
9730 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9731 font table. */
9732
9733 static void
9734 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9735 {
9736 Lisp_Object frame;
9737
9738 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9739 if (font->driver->check)
9740 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9741 }
9742
9743 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9744
9745 \f
9746 /***********************************************************************
9747 Initialization
9748 ***********************************************************************/
9749
9750 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9751 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9752 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9753 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9754
9755 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9756 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9757 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9758
9759 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9760 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9761 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9762 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9763 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9764 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9765 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9766 };
9767
9768 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9769
9770 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9771
9772 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9773
9774 static int x_initialized;
9775
9776 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
9777 static int x_session_initialized;
9778 #endif
9779
9780 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9781 the screen number from the server number. */
9782 static int
9783 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9784 {
9785 int seen_colon = 0;
9786 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
9787 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
9788 int length_until_period = 0;
9789
9790 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9791 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9792 length_until_period++;
9793
9794 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9795 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9796 name1 += 4;
9797 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9798 name2 += 4;
9799 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9800 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9801 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9802 name1 += system_name_length;
9803 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9804 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9805 name2 += system_name_length;
9806 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9807 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9808 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9809 name1 += length_until_period;
9810 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9811 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9812 name2 += length_until_period;
9813
9814 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9815 {
9816 if (*name1 == ':')
9817 seen_colon++;
9818 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9819 return 1;
9820 }
9821 return (seen_colon
9822 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9823 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9824 }
9825
9826 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9827 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9828 to 5. */
9829 static void
9830 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9831 {
9832 int nr = 0;
9833 int off = 0;
9834
9835 while (!(mask & 1))
9836 {
9837 off++;
9838 mask >>= 1;
9839 }
9840
9841 while (mask & 1)
9842 {
9843 nr++;
9844 mask >>= 1;
9845 }
9846
9847 *offset = off;
9848 *bits = nr;
9849 }
9850
9851 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9852 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9853
9854 int
9855 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9856 {
9857 int dpy_ok = 1;
9858 Display *dpy;
9859
9860 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9861 if (dpy)
9862 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9863 else
9864 dpy_ok = 0;
9865 return dpy_ok;
9866 }
9867
9868 #ifdef USE_GTK
9869 static void
9870 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level, const gchar *message, gpointer user_data)
9871 {
9872 if (!strstr (message, "g_set_prgname"))
9873 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, message);
9874 }
9875 #endif
9876
9877 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9878 the structure that describes the open display.
9879 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9880
9881 struct x_display_info *
9882 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9883 {
9884 int connection;
9885 Display *dpy;
9886 struct terminal *terminal;
9887 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9888 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9889 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9890
9891 BLOCK_INPUT;
9892
9893 if (!x_initialized)
9894 {
9895 x_initialize ();
9896 ++x_initialized;
9897 }
9898
9899 if (! x_display_ok (SDATA (display_name)))
9900 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SDATA (display_name));
9901
9902 #ifdef USE_GTK
9903 {
9904 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9905 int argc;
9906 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9907 char **argv2 = argv;
9908 guint id;
9909
9910 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9911 {
9912 xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9913 }
9914 else
9915 {
9916 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9917 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9918
9919 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9920 argv[argc] = 0;
9921
9922 argc = 0;
9923 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9924
9925 if (! NILP (display_name))
9926 {
9927 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9928 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
9929 }
9930
9931 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9932 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9933
9934 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9935
9936 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9937 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9938 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9939 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9940 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9941 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9942
9943 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9944 fixup_locale ();
9945 xg_initialize ();
9946
9947 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
9948
9949 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9950 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9951
9952 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9953 {
9954 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9955 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9956
9957 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9958 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9959
9960 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9961 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
9962 }
9963
9964 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9965 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9966 }
9967 }
9968 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9969 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9970 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9971 errors with X11R5:
9972 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9973 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9974 So let's not use it until R6. */
9975 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9976 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9977 #endif
9978
9979 {
9980 int argc = 0;
9981 char *argv[3];
9982
9983 argv[0] = "";
9984 argc = 1;
9985 if (xrm_option)
9986 {
9987 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9988 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9989 }
9990 turn_on_atimers (0);
9991 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
9992 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9993 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9994 &argc, argv);
9995 turn_on_atimers (1);
9996
9997 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9998 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9999 fixup_locale ();
10000 #endif
10001 }
10002
10003 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10004 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10005 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10006 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10007 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10008
10009 /* Detect failure. */
10010 if (dpy == 0)
10011 {
10012 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10013 return 0;
10014 }
10015
10016 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10017
10018 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10019 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10020 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10021
10022 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10023
10024 {
10025 struct x_display_info *share;
10026 Lisp_Object tail;
10027
10028 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10029 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10030 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10031 SDATA (display_name)))
10032 break;
10033 if (share)
10034 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10035 else
10036 {
10037 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10038 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10039 terminal->kboard->Vwindow_system = Qx;
10040
10041 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10042 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10043 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10044 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10045 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10046
10047 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10048 {
10049 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10050
10051 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10052 list of terminals. */
10053 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10054 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10055 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10056 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10057
10058 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10059 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10060 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10061 terminal->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10062 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10063 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10064 BLOCK_INPUT;
10065 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10066 terminal_list = terminal;
10067 UNGCPRO;
10068 }
10069
10070 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10071 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10072 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10073 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10074 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10075 }
10076 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10077 }
10078
10079 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10080 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10081 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10082
10083 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10084 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10085 x_display_name_list);
10086 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10087
10088 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10089
10090 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10091 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10092 strncpy (terminal->name, SDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10093 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10094
10095 #if 0
10096 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10097 #endif /* ! 0 */
10098
10099 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10100 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10101 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10102 + 2);
10103 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10104 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10105
10106 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10107 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10108
10109 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10110 #ifdef USE_GTK
10111 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10112 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10113 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10114
10115 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10116 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10117
10118 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10119 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10120 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10121 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10122 #else
10123 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10124 #endif
10125 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10126 all versions. */
10127 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10128
10129 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10130 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10131 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10132 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10133 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10134 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10135 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10136 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10137 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10138 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10139 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10140 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10141 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10142 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10143 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10144 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10145 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10146 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10147 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10148 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10149 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10150 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10151 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10152 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10153 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10154 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10155 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10156 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10157
10158 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10159 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10160 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10161
10162 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10163 {
10164 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10165 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10166 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10167 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10168 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10169 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10170 }
10171
10172 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10173 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10174 {
10175 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10176 {
10177 Lisp_Object value;
10178 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10179 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10180 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10181 Qnil, Qnil);
10182 if (STRINGP (value)
10183 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10184 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10185 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10186 }
10187 }
10188 else
10189 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10190 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10191
10192 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10193 {
10194 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10195 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10196 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10197 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10198 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10199 for example). */
10200 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10201 double d;
10202 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10203 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10204 }
10205 #endif
10206
10207 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10208 {
10209 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10210 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10211 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10212 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10213 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10214 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10215 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10216 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10217 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10218 }
10219
10220 {
10221 const struct
10222 {
10223 const char *name;
10224 Atom *atom;
10225 } atom_refs[] = {
10226 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10227 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10228 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10229 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10230 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10231 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10232 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10233 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10234 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10235 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10236 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10237 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10238 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10239 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10240 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10241 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10242 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10243 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10244 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10245 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10246 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10247 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10248 /* For properties of font. */
10249 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10250 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10251 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10252 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10253 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10254 /* Ghostscript support. */
10255 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10256 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10257 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10258 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10259 /* EWMH */
10260 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10261 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10262 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10263 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10264 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10265 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10266 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10267 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10268 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10269 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10270 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10271 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10272 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10273 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10274 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10275 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10276 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10277 /* Session management */
10278 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10279 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10280 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10281 };
10282
10283 int i;
10284 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10285 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10286 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10287 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (sizeof (Atom) * total_atom_count);
10288 char **atom_names = xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count);
10289 char xsettings_atom_name[64];
10290
10291 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10292 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10293
10294 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10295 snprintf (xsettings_atom_name, sizeof (xsettings_atom_name),
10296 "_XSETTINGS_S%d", XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10297 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10298
10299 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10300 False, atoms_return);
10301
10302 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10303 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10304
10305 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10306 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10307
10308 xfree (atom_names);
10309 xfree (atoms_return);
10310 }
10311
10312 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10313 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10314 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10315 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10316
10317 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10318 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10319 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10320
10321 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10322 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10323
10324 {
10325 dpyinfo->gray
10326 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10327 gray_bitmap_bits,
10328 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10329 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10330 }
10331
10332 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10333 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10334 #endif
10335
10336 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10337
10338 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10339 if (connection != 0)
10340 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10341
10342 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10343 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10344 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10345
10346 #ifdef SIGIO
10347 if (interrupt_input)
10348 init_sigio (connection);
10349 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10350
10351 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10352 {
10353 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10354 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10355 Font font;
10356
10357 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10358 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10359 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10360 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10361 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10362 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10363 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10364 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10365 abort ();
10366 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10367 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10368 x_uncatch_errors ();
10369 }
10370 #endif
10371
10372 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10373 for debugging X code. */
10374 {
10375 Lisp_Object value;
10376 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10377 build_string ("synchronous"),
10378 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10379 Qnil, Qnil);
10380 if (STRINGP (value)
10381 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10382 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10383 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10384 }
10385
10386 {
10387 Lisp_Object value;
10388 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10389 build_string ("useXIM"),
10390 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10391 Qnil, Qnil);
10392 #ifdef USE_XIM
10393 if (STRINGP (value)
10394 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "false")
10395 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "off")))
10396 use_xim = 0;
10397 #else
10398 if (STRINGP (value)
10399 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10400 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10401 use_xim = 1;
10402 #endif
10403 }
10404
10405 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10406 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10407 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10408 tty. */
10409 if (terminal->id == 1)
10410 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10411 #endif
10412
10413 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10414
10415 return dpyinfo;
10416 }
10417 \f
10418 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10419 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10420
10421 void
10422 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10423 {
10424 struct terminal *t;
10425
10426 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10427 X display. */
10428 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10429 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10430 {
10431 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10432 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10433 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10434 x_session_close ();
10435 #endif
10436 delete_terminal (t);
10437 break;
10438 }
10439
10440 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10441
10442 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10443 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10444 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10445 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10446 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10447 else
10448 {
10449 Lisp_Object tail;
10450
10451 tail = x_display_name_list;
10452 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10453 {
10454 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10455 {
10456 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10457 break;
10458 }
10459 tail = XCDR (tail);
10460 }
10461 }
10462
10463 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10464 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10465
10466 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10467 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10468 else
10469 {
10470 struct x_display_info *tail;
10471
10472 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10473 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10474 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10475 }
10476
10477 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10478 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10479 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10480 xfree (dpyinfo);
10481 }
10482
10483 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10484
10485 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10486 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10487 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10488 that slows us down. */
10489
10490 static void
10491 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10492 {
10493 BLOCK_INPUT;
10494 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10495 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10496 {
10497 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10498 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10499 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10500 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10501 }
10502 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10503 }
10504
10505 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10506 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10507 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10508 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10509 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10510 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10511 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10512
10513 void
10514 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10515 {
10516 BLOCK_INPUT;
10517 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10518 {
10519 EMACS_TIME interval;
10520
10521 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10522 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10523 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10524 }
10525 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10526 }
10527
10528 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10529
10530 \f
10531 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10532
10533 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10534
10535 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10536 {
10537 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10538 x_produce_glyphs,
10539 x_write_glyphs,
10540 x_insert_glyphs,
10541 x_clear_end_of_line,
10542 x_scroll_run,
10543 x_after_update_window_line,
10544 x_update_window_begin,
10545 x_update_window_end,
10546 x_cursor_to,
10547 x_flush,
10548 #ifdef XFlush
10549 x_flush,
10550 #else
10551 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10552 #endif
10553 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10554 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10555 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10556 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10557 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10558 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10559 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10560 x_draw_glyph_string,
10561 x_define_frame_cursor,
10562 x_clear_frame_area,
10563 x_draw_window_cursor,
10564 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10565 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10566 };
10567
10568
10569 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10570 void
10571 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10572 {
10573 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10574
10575 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10576 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10577 if (!terminal->name)
10578 return;
10579
10580 BLOCK_INPUT;
10581 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10582 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10583 X display. */
10584 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10585 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10586 #endif
10587
10588 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10589 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10590 if (dpyinfo->display)
10591 {
10592 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10593 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10594
10595 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10596 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10597 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10598 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10599
10600 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10601 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10602 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10603 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10604 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10605 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10606 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10607 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10608 leaks in other situations. */
10609 #if 0
10610 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10611 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10612 #else
10613 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10614 #endif
10615 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10616 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10617 closing all the displays. */
10618 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10619 #endif
10620
10621 #ifdef USE_GTK
10622 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10623 #else
10624 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10625 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10626 #else
10627 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10628 #endif
10629 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10630 }
10631
10632 /* Mark as dead. */
10633 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10634 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10635 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10636 }
10637
10638 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10639 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10640
10641 static struct terminal *
10642 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10643 {
10644 struct terminal *terminal;
10645
10646 terminal = create_terminal ();
10647
10648 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10649 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10650 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10651
10652 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10653
10654 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10655 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10656 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10657 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10658 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10659 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10660 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10661 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10662 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10663 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10664 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10665 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10666 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10667 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10668 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10669 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10670 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10671 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10672 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10673 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10674
10675 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10676 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10677
10678 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10679 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10680 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10681 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10682 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10683 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10684 off the bottom. */
10685
10686 return terminal;
10687 }
10688
10689 void
10690 x_initialize (void)
10691 {
10692 baud_rate = 19200;
10693
10694 x_noop_count = 0;
10695 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10696 any_help_event_p = 0;
10697 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10698 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10699 x_session_initialized = 0;
10700 #endif
10701
10702 #ifdef USE_GTK
10703 current_count = -1;
10704 #endif
10705
10706 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10707 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10708
10709 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10710 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10711
10712 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10713
10714 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10715 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10716 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10717 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10718 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10719 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10720 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10721
10722 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10723 #endif
10724
10725 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10726 #ifndef USE_GTK
10727 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10728 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10729 #endif
10730 #endif
10731
10732 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10733 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10734 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10735
10736 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10737 original error handler. */
10738 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10739 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10740
10741 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10742
10743 xgselect_initialize ();
10744 }
10745
10746
10747 void
10748 syms_of_xterm (void)
10749 {
10750 x_error_message = NULL;
10751
10752 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10753 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10754
10755 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10756 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10757
10758 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10759 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern_c_string ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10760
10761 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10762 Qlatin_1 = intern_c_string ("latin-1");
10763
10764 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10765 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10766
10767 #ifdef USE_GTK
10768 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10769 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10770
10771 Qx_gtk_map_stock = intern_c_string ("x-gtk-map-stock");
10772 staticpro (&Qx_gtk_map_stock);
10773 #endif
10774
10775 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10776 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10777 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10778 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10779 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10780 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10781 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10782 sizes. */);
10783 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10784
10785 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10786 &x_underline_at_descent_line,
10787 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10788 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10789 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10790 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10791 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10792
10793 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10794 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10795 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10796 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10797 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10798 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10799 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10800 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10801 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10802
10803 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10804 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10805 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10806 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10807 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10808 With MS Windows, the value is t. */);
10809 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10810 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10811 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10812 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10813 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10814 #elif USE_GTK
10815 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10816 #else
10817 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10818 #endif
10819 #else
10820 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10821 #endif
10822
10823 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10824 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10825
10826 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10827 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10828 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10829 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10830 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10831 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10832 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10833 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10834 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10835
10836 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10837 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10838 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10839 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10840 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10841 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10842
10843 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10844 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10845 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10846 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10847 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10848 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10849
10850 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10851 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10852 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10853 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10854 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10855 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10856
10857 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10858 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10859 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10860 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10861 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10862 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10863
10864 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10865 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10866 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10867 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10868 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10869 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10870 }
10871
10872 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10873